d: Remove the d_critsec_size target hook.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * D Language and ABI:: Controlling D ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 Similarly, there is a @code{targetdm} variable for hooks that are
111 specific to the D language front end, documented as ``D Target Hook''.
112 This is declared in @file{d/d-target.h}, the initializer
113 @code{TARGETDM_INITIALIZER} in @file{d/d-target-def.h}. If targets
114 initialize @code{targetdm} themselves, they should set
115 @code{target_has_targetdm=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default
116 definition is used.
117
118 @node Driver
119 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
120 @cindex driver
121 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
122
123 @c prevent bad page break with this line
124 You can control the compilation driver.
125
126 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
127 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
128 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
129
130 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
131 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
132 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
133 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
134 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
135 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
136
137 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
138 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
139 that the other specs are easier to write.
140
141 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
142 @end defmac
143
144 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
145 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
146 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
147 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
148 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
149
150 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
151 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
152 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
153 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
154 everywhere it occurs.
155
156 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
157 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
158 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPP_SPEC
164 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
166 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
167
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
172 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
173 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
174 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
175 @end defmac
176
177 @defmac CC1_SPEC
178 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
179 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
180 front ends.
181 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
182 for GCC to pass to front ends.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 @end defmac
186
187 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
188 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
189 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
190 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
191
192 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
193 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
194 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
195 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
200 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
201 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
202 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
208 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
209 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
210 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
211 an example of this.
212
213 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
214 @end defmac
215
216 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
217 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
218 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
219 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
220 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
221 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
222
223 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
224 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
225 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
226 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LINK_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
231 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
232 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
233
234 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIB_SPEC
238 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
239 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
240 command given to the linker.
241
242 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
243 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
244 @end defmac
245
246 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
247 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
248 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
249 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
250 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
251
252 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
253 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
254 @end defmac
255
256 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
257 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
258 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
259 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
260 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
261 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
262 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
263 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
264 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
265 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
269 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
270 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
271 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
272 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
273 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
274 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
278 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
279 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
280 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
281 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
288
289 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
290 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
291 @end defmac
292
293 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
294 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
295 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
296 the very end of the command given to the linker.
297
298 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
299 @end defmac
300
301 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
302 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
303 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
304 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
305 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
306 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
307 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
308 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
309 @end defmac
310
311 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
312 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
313 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
314 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
318 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
319 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
320 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
321 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
322 @end defmac
323
324 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
325 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
326 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
327 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
328
329 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
330 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
331 string constant that provides the specification.
332
333 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
334
335 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
336 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
337 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
338 these definitions.
339
340 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
341 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
342 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
343 used.
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
346
347 @smallexample
348 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
349 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
350
351 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
352 @end smallexample
353
354 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
355 @smallexample
356 #undef CPP_SPEC
357 #define CPP_SPEC \
358 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
359 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
360 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
361 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
362
363 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
364 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
365 @end smallexample
366
367 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
368 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
369
370 @smallexample
371 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
372 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
373 @end smallexample
374 @end defmac
375
376 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
377 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
378 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
379 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
380 @end defmac
381
382 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
383 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
384 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
385 @end defmac
386
387 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
388 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
389 The default value of this macro is empty string.
390 @end defmac
391
392 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
393 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
394 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
395 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
396 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
397 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
398 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
399 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
400 @end defmac
401
402 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
403 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
404 @end deftypevr
405
406 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
407 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
408 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
409 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
410 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
411
412 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
413 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
414 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
415 @xref{Target Fragment}.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
419 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
420 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
421 indicates an absolute file name.
422 @end defmac
423
424 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
425 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
426 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
427 when the compiler is built as a cross
428 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
429 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
430 @end defmac
431
432 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
435 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
437 is built as a cross compiler.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
443 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
445 is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
449 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
450 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
451 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
452 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
453 is built as a cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
457 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
458 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
459 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
460 @end defmac
461
462 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
463 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
464 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
465 cross compiler.
466 @end defmac
467
468 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
469 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
470 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
471 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
472 initialize the necessary environment variables.
473 @end defmac
474
475 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
476 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
478 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
479 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
480 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
481
482 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
483 replacement.
484 @end defmac
485
486 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
487 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
488 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
489 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
490 @end defmac
491
492 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
493 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
494 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
495 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
496 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
497 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
498 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
499 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
500 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
501
502 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
503 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
504 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
505 for C++-only directories,
506 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
507 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
508 the array with a null element.
509
510 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
511 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
512 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
513 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
514
515 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
516
517 @smallexample
518 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
519 @{ \
520 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
521 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
522 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
523 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
524 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
525 @}
526 @end smallexample
527 @end defmac
528
529 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
530
531 @enumerate
532 @item
533 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
534
535 @item
536 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
537 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
538 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
539
540 @item
541 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
542
543 @item
544 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
545 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
546
547 @item
548 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
549
550 @item
551 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
552
553 @item
554 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
555 compiler.
556 @end enumerate
557
558 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
559
560 @enumerate
561 @item
562 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563
564 @item
565 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
566 value based on the installed toolchain location.
567
568 @item
569 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
570 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
571
572 @item
573 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
574 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
575
576 @item
577 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
581 compiler.
582
583 @item
584 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
585 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
589 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
593 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
594 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
595
596 @item
597 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
598 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
599 @file{/lib/}.
600
601 @item
602 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
603 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
617 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
618 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
619 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
620 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
621 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
622 finished command line option processing your code can use those
623 results freely.
624
625 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
626 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
627 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
628 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
629
630 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
631 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
632 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
633 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
634 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
635 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
636 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
637 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
638 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
639 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
640
641 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
642 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
643 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
644 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
645 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
646 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
647 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
648 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
649 preprocessing.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
653 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
654 and is used for the target operating system instead.
655 @end defmac
656
657 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
660 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
661 it yourself.
662 @end defmac
663
664 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
665 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
666 any target-specific headers.
667 @end deftypevar
668
669 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
670 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
671 Its default setting is 0.
672 @end deftypevr
673
674 @cindex optional hardware or system features
675 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
676
677 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
678 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
680 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
681 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
682 definition does nothing but return true.
683
684 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
685 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
686 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
687 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
688 via attributes).
689 @end deftypefn
690
691 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
692 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
693 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
694 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
695 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
696 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
697 default definition does nothing but return false.
698
699 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
700 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
701 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
702 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
706 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
710 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
714 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
715 @end deftypefn
716
717 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
718 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
722 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
723 @end deftypefn
724
725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
726 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
727 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
728 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
729 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
730 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
731 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
732 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
733 @end deftypefn
734
735 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
736 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
737 but is only used in the C
738 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
739 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
740 frontends.
741 @end defmac
742
743 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
744 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
745 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
746 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
747 options are processed once
748 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
749 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
750 options passed explicitly.
751
752 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
753 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
754 @code{optimize} attribute.
755 @end deftypevr
756
757 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
758 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
759 @end deftypefn
760
761 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
762 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
763 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
764 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
765 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
766 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
767
768 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
769 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
770 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
771 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
772 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
773 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
774 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
775
776 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
777 is 0.
778 @end defmac
779
780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
781 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
782 @end deftypefn
783
784 @node Per-Function Data
785 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
786 @cindex per-function data
787 @cindex data structures
788
789 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
790 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
791 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
792 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
793 when another one comes along.
794
795 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
796 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
797 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
798 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
799 to their own specific data.
800
801 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
802 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
803 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
804 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
805
806 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
807 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
808 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
809 function, for level 0.
810
811 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
812 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
813 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
814 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
815 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
816 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
817 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
818 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
819 longer supported.
820
821 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
822 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
823 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
824 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
825 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
826 @end defmac
827
828 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
829 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
830 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
831 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
832 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
833 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
834
835 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
836 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
837 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
838 @end deftypevar
839
840 @node Storage Layout
841 @section Storage Layout
842 @cindex storage layout
843
844 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
845 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
846 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
847 @xref{Run-time Target}.
848
849 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
850 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
851 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
852 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
853 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
854 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
855 macro need not be a constant.
856
857 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
858 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
863 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
864 @end defmac
865
866 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
867 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
868 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
869 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
870 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
871 macro need not be a constant.
872 @end defmac
873
874 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
875 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
876 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
877 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
878 the order of words in memory.
879 @end defmac
880
881 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
882 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
883 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
884 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
885 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
886
887 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
888 multi-word integers.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
892 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
893 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
894 @end defmac
895
896 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
897 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
898 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
899 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
904 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
905 @end defmac
906
907 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
908 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
909 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
910 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
911 @end defmac
912
913 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
914 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
915 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
916 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
917 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
918 @end defmac
919
920 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
921 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
922 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
923 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
924 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
925 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
926 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
927
928 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
929 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
930 @end defmac
931
932 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
933 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
934 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
935 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
936 scalar type.
937
938 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
939 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
940 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
941 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
942 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
943 counterparts.
944
945 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
946 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
947 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
948 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
949 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
950 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
951
952 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
953 @end defmac
954
955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
956 Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
957 @end deftypefn
958
959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
960 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
961 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
962 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
963 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
964 pointer} types.
965
966 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
967 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
968 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
969 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
970 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
971 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
972 the signedness may be different.
973
974 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
975
976 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
977 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
978 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
979 @end deftypefn
980
981 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
982 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
983 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
984 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
985 size of an integer.
986 @end defmac
987
988 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
989 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
990 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
991 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
992 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
993 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
994 @end defmac
995
996 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
997 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
998 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
999 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1000 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1001 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1002 @end defmac
1003
1004 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1005 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1006 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1007 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1008 @end defmac
1009
1010 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1011 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1012 @end defmac
1013
1014 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1015 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1016 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1017 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1018 @end defmac
1019
1020 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1021 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1022 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1023 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1024 @end deftypevr
1025
1026 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1027 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1028 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1029 @end defmac
1030
1031 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1032 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1033 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1034 @end defmac
1035
1036 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1037 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1038 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1039 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1040 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1041 @end defmac
1042
1043 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1044 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1045 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1046 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1047 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1048 @end defmac
1049
1050 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1051 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1052 type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1053 applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1054 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1055 field alignment has not been set by the
1056 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field}
1057 may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1058 of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
1059 @end defmac
1060
1061 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1062 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1063 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1064
1065 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066
1067 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1068 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1069 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1070 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1071 @end defmac
1072
1073 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1074 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1075 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1076 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct for functions and
1077 objects with static storage duration. The alignment of automatic
1078 objects may exceed the object file format maximum up to the maximum
1079 supported by GCC. If not defined, the default value is
1080 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1081
1082 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1083 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1084 a 32-bit host e.g.@: @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1085 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1086 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1087 @end defmac
1088
1089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_LOWER_LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (tree @var{decl})
1090 Define this hook to lower alignment of local, parm or result
1091 decl @samp{(@var{decl})}.
1092 @end deftypefn
1093
1094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STATIC_RTX_ALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode})
1095 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a
1096 statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry. @var{mode}
1097 is the mode of the rtx. The default implementation returns
1098 @samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
1099 @end deftypefn
1100
1101 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1102 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1103 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1104 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1105 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1106
1107 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1108
1109 @findex strcpy
1110 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1111 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1112 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1113 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1114 @end defmac
1115
1116 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1117 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1118 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1119 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1120 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1121
1122 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1123 @end defmac
1124
1125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{constant}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{basic_align})
1126 This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being
1127 placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align}
1128 is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.
1129
1130 The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}.
1131
1132 The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string
1133 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1134 constants can be done inline. The function
1135 @code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition.
1136 @end deftypefn
1137
1138 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1139 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1140 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1141 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1142 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1143
1144 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1145
1146 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1147 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1148
1149 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1150 @end defmac
1151
1152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1153 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1154 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1155 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1156 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1157 the vector element type.
1158 @end deftypefn
1159
1160 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1161 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1162 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1163 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1164 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1165 align the slot.
1166
1167 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1168 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1169 be used.
1170
1171 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1172 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1173
1174 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1175 @end defmac
1176
1177 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1178 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1179 variable @var{decl}.
1180
1181 If this macro is not defined, then
1182 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1183 is used.
1184
1185 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1186 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1187
1188 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1189 @end defmac
1190
1191 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1192 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1193 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1194 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1195
1196 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1197 @end defmac
1198
1199 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1200 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1201 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1202
1203 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1204 @end defmac
1205
1206 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1207 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1208 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1209
1210 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1211 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1212 @end defmac
1213
1214 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1215 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1216 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1217 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1218 @end defmac
1219
1220 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1221 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1222 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1223
1224 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1225 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1226 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1227 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1228 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1229
1230 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1231 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1232 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1233 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1234
1235 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1236 structure.
1237
1238 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1239 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1240
1241 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1242 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1243 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1244 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1245
1246 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1247 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1248 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1249
1250 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1251 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1252 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1253
1254 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1255 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1256 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1257
1258 @smallexample
1259 struct foo1
1260 @{
1261 char x;
1262 char :0;
1263 char y;
1264 @};
1265
1266 struct foo2
1267 @{
1268 char x;
1269 int :0;
1270 char y;
1271 @};
1272
1273 main ()
1274 @{
1275 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1276 sizeof (struct foo1));
1277 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1278 sizeof (struct foo2));
1279 exit (0);
1280 @}
1281 @end smallexample
1282
1283 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1284 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1285 @end defmac
1286
1287 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1288 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1289 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1290 @end defmac
1291
1292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1293 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1294 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1295 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1296 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1297 @end deftypefn
1298
1299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1300 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1301 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1302 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1303
1304 The default is @code{false}.
1305 @end deftypefn
1306
1307 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1308 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1309 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1310
1311 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1312 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1313 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1314 retain the field's mode.
1315
1316 Normally, this is not needed.
1317 @end deftypefn
1318
1319 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1320 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1321 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1322 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1323 @var{specified}.
1324
1325 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1326 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1327 @end defmac
1328
1329 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1330 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1331 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1332 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1333 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1334 (DImode)} is assumed.
1335 @end defmac
1336
1337 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1338 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1339 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1340 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1341 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1342 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1343 having its mode specified.
1344
1345 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1346 would most commonly define this macro if the
1347 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1348 64-bit mode.
1349 @end defmac
1350
1351 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1352 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1353 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1354 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1355
1356 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1357 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1358 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1359 @end defmac
1360
1361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1362 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1363 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1364 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1365 targets.
1366 @end deftypefn
1367
1368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1369 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1370 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1371 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1372 targets.
1373 @end deftypefn
1374
1375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1376 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1377 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1378 @end deftypefn
1379
1380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1381 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1382 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1383 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1384 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1385 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1386 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1387 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1388 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1389 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1390 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1391 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1392
1393 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1394 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1395 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1396 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1397 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1398 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1399 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1400
1401 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1402 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1403 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1404 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1405 may affect its placement.
1406 @end deftypefn
1407
1408 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1409 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1410 @end deftypefn
1411
1412 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1413 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1414 @end deftypefn
1415
1416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1417 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1418 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1419 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1420 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1421 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1422 usage.
1423 @end deftypefn
1424
1425 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1426 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1427 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1428 @end deftypefn
1429
1430 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1431 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1432 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1433 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1434 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1435 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1436 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1437 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1438 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1439 string constant.
1440
1441 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1442 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1443 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1444 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1445 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1446 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1447 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1448 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1449 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1450 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1451 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1452 spaces in your string.
1453
1454 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1455 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1456 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1457 before mangling.
1458
1459 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1460 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1461 types.
1462 @end deftypefn
1463
1464 @node Type Layout
1465 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1466
1467 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1468 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1469 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1470 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1471
1472 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1475 @end defmac
1476
1477 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1478 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1479 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1480 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1481 unit.)
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1485 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1486 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1490 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1491 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1492 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1493 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1494 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1495 @end defmac
1496
1497 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1498 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1499 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1500 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1501 macro must be at least 64.
1502 @end defmac
1503
1504 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1505 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1506 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1507 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1508 @end defmac
1509
1510 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1511 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1512 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1513 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1514 @end defmac
1515
1516 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1517 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1518 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1519 @end defmac
1520
1521 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1522 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1523 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1524 words.
1525 @end defmac
1526
1527 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1528 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1529 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1530 words.
1531 @end defmac
1532
1533 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1534 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1535 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1537 @end defmac
1538
1539 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1540 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1541 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1542 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1543 @end defmac
1544
1545 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1546 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1547 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1548 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1549 @end defmac
1550
1551 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1552 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1553 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1554 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1555 @end defmac
1556
1557 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1558 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1559 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1560 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1561 @end defmac
1562
1563 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1564 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1565 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1566 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1567 @end defmac
1568
1569 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1570 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1571 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1572 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1573 @end defmac
1574
1575 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1576 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1577 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1578 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1579 @end defmac
1580
1581 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1582 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1583 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1584 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1585 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1586 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1587 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1588 @end defmac
1589
1590 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1591 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1592 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1593 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1594 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1595 is the default.
1596 @end defmac
1597
1598 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1599 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1600 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1601 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1602 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1603 @end defmac
1604
1605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1606 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1607 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1608 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1609 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1610
1611 The default is to return false.
1612 @end deftypefn
1613
1614 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1615 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1616 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1617 contents of the string.
1618
1619 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1620 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1621 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1622 of the data type names defined in the function
1623 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1624 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1625 compiler to crash on startup.
1626
1627 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1628 int"}.
1629 @end defmac
1630
1631 @defmac SIZETYPE
1632 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1633 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1634 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1635 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1636 is extracted.
1637
1638 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1639
1640 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1644 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1645 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1646 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1647 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1648
1649 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1650 @end defmac
1651
1652 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1653 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1654 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1655 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1656 information.
1657
1658 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1659 @end defmac
1660
1661 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1662 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1663 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1664 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1665 @end defmac
1666
1667 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1668 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1669 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1670 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1671 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1672 information.
1673
1674 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1675 @end defmac
1676
1677 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1678 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1679 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1680 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1681 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1682
1683 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1684 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1685 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1686 @end defmac
1687
1688 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1689 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1690 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1691 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1692 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1693
1694 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1695 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1696 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1697 int}.
1698 @end defmac
1699
1700 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1701 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1702 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1703 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1706 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1707 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1709 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1710 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1711 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1712 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1713 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1714 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1715 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1716 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1717 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1718 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1719 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1720 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1721 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1722 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1723 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1724 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1725 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1726 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1727 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1728 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1729 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1730 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1731 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1732 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1733 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1734 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1735 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1736 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1737
1738 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1739 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1740 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1741 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1742 these macros are null pointers.
1743 @end defmac
1744
1745 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1746 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1747 that looks like:
1748
1749 @smallexample
1750 struct @{
1751 union @{
1752 void (*fn)();
1753 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1754 @};
1755 ptrdiff_t delta;
1756 @};
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759 @noindent
1760 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1761 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1762 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1763 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1764 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1765 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1766 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1767 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1768
1769 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1770 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1771 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1772 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1773 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1774 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1775 architecture, you should define this macro to
1776 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1777
1778 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1779 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1780 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1781 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1782 @end defmac
1783
1784 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1785 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1786 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1787 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1788 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1789 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1790 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1791
1792 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1793 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1794 @end defmac
1795
1796 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1797 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1798 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1799 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1800 when special alignment is necessary. */
1801 @end defmac
1802
1803 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1804 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1805 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1806 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1807 of words in each data entry.
1808 @end defmac
1809
1810 @node Registers
1811 @section Register Usage
1812 @cindex register usage
1813
1814 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1815 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1816
1817 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1818 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1819 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1820 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1821 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1822
1823 @menu
1824 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1825 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1826 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1827 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1828 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1829 @end menu
1830
1831 @node Register Basics
1832 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1833
1834 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1835 Registers have various characteristics.
1836
1837 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1838 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1839 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1840 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1841 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1842 @end defmac
1843
1844 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1845 @cindex fixed register
1846 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1847 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1848 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1849 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1850 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1851 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1852 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1853
1854 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1855 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1856 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1857
1858 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1859 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1860 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1861 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1862 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1863 @end defmac
1864
1865 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1866 @cindex call-used register
1867 @cindex call-clobbered register
1868 @cindex call-saved register
1869 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1870 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1871 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1872 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1873 function calls.
1874
1875 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1876 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1877 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1878
1879 Exactly one of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} and @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}
1880 must be defined. Modern ports should define @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}.
1881 @end defmac
1882
1883 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1884 @cindex call-used register
1885 @cindex call-clobbered register
1886 @cindex call-saved register
1887 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1888 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1889 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1890
1891 Exactly one of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} and @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}
1892 must be defined. Modern ports should define @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}.
1893 @end defmac
1894
1895 @cindex call-used register
1896 @cindex call-clobbered register
1897 @cindex call-saved register
1898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const predefined_function_abi &} TARGET_FNTYPE_ABI (const_tree @var{type})
1899 Return the ABI used by a function with type @var{type}; see the
1900 definition of @code{predefined_function_abi} for details of the ABI
1901 descriptor. Targets only need to define this hook if they support
1902 interoperability between several ABIs in the same translation unit.
1903 @end deftypefn
1904
1905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const predefined_function_abi &} TARGET_INSN_CALLEE_ABI (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
1906 This hook returns a description of the ABI used by the target of
1907 call instruction @var{insn}; see the definition of
1908 @code{predefined_function_abi} for details of the ABI descriptor.
1909 Only the global function @code{insn_callee_abi} should call this hook
1910 directly.
1911
1912 Targets only need to define this hook if they support
1913 interoperability between several ABIs in the same translation unit.
1914 @end deftypefn
1915
1916 @cindex call-used register
1917 @cindex call-clobbered register
1918 @cindex call-saved register
1919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (unsigned int @var{abi_id}, unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1920 ABIs usually specify that calls must preserve the full contents
1921 of a particular register, or that calls can alter any part of a
1922 particular register. This information is captured by the target macro
1923 @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}. However, some ABIs specify that calls
1924 must preserve certain bits of a particular register but can alter others.
1925 This hook should return true if this applies to at least one of the
1926 registers in @samp{(reg:@var{mode} @var{regno})}, and if as a result the
1927 call would alter part of the @var{mode} value. For example, if a call
1928 preserves the low 32 bits of a 64-bit hard register @var{regno} but can
1929 clobber the upper 32 bits, this hook should return true for a 64-bit mode
1930 but false for a 32-bit mode.
1931
1932 The value of @var{abi_id} comes from the @code{predefined_function_abi}
1933 structure that describes the ABI of the call; see the definition of the
1934 structure for more details. If (as is usual) the target uses the same ABI
1935 for all functions in a translation unit, @var{abi_id} is always 0.
1936
1937 The default implementation returns false, which is correct
1938 for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.
1939 @end deftypefn
1940
1941 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_GET_MULTILIB_ABI_NAME (void)
1942 This hook returns name of multilib ABI name.
1943 @end deftypefn
1944
1945 @findex fixed_regs
1946 @findex call_used_regs
1947 @findex global_regs
1948 @findex reg_names
1949 @findex reg_class_contents
1950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1951 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1952 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1953 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1954 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1955 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1956 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1957 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1958 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1959 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1960 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1961 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1962 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1963 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1964 command options have been applied.
1965
1966 @cindex disabling certain registers
1967 @cindex controlling register usage
1968 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1969 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1970 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1971 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1972 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1973 that shouldn't be used.
1974
1975 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1976 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1977 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1978 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1979 @end deftypefn
1980
1981 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1982 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1983 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1984 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1985 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1986 outbound register.
1987 @end defmac
1988
1989 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1990 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1991 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1992 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1993 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1994 register.
1995 @end defmac
1996
1997 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1998 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1999 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
2000 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2001 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2002 gotos.
2003 @end defmac
2004
2005 @defmac PC_REGNUM
2006 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2007 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2008 @end defmac
2009
2010 @node Allocation Order
2011 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2012 @cindex order of register allocation
2013 @cindex register allocation order
2014
2015 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2016 Registers are allocated in order.
2017
2018 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2019 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2020 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2021 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2022
2023 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2024 (all else being equal).
2025
2026 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2027 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2028 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2029 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2030 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2031 @end defmac
2032
2033 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2034 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2035 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2036
2037 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2038 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2039 register; and so on.
2040
2041 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2042 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2043
2044 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2045 @end defmac
2046
2047 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2048 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2049 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2050 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2051 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2052 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
2053 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
2054 @end defmac
2055
2056 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2057 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2058 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2059 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2060 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2061 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2062 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2063 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2064
2065 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2066 @end defmac
2067
2068 @node Values in Registers
2069 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2070
2071 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2072 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2073 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2074
2075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2076 This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2077 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2078 @var{mode}. This hook must never return zero, even if a register
2079 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with
2080 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or
2081 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead.
2082
2083 The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}.
2084 @end deftypefn
2085
2086 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2087 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2088 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2089 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2090 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2091 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2092 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2093
2094 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2095 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2096 nonzero.
2097
2098 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2099 @code{subreg_get_info}
2100 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2101 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2102 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2103 registers and so not be representable.
2104 @end defmac
2105
2106 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2107 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2108 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2109 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2110 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2111 @end defmac
2112
2113 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2114 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2115 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2116 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2117 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2118 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2119 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2120 @end defmac
2121
2122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2123 This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value
2124 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2125 registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true
2126 unconditionally.
2127
2128 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2129 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2130
2131 @cindex register pairs
2132 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2133 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject
2134 odd register numbers for such modes.
2135
2136 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2137 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2138 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2139 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2140
2141 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2142 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2143 this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define
2144 patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is
2145 useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2146 and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer
2147 modes to be tieable.
2148
2149 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2150 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2151 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2152 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2153 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2154 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2155
2156 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2157 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2158 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2159 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2160 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2161 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2162 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2163 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2164 register, so you can define this hook to say so.
2165
2166 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2167 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2168 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2169 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2170 constraints for those instructions.
2171
2172 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2173 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2174 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2175 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2176 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2177 @end deftypefn
2178
2179 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2180 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2181 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2182
2183 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2184 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2185 handler.
2186
2187 The default is always nonzero.
2188 @end defmac
2189
2190 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2})
2191 This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible
2192 in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2193
2194 If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2195 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always
2196 the same for any @var{r}, then
2197 @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2198 should be true. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2199 this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the
2200 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2201
2202 You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as
2203 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2204 allocation. The default definition returns true unconditionally.
2205 @end deftypefn
2206
2207 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2208 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2209 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2210
2211 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2212 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2213
2214 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2215 @end deftypefn
2216
2217 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2218 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2219 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2220 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2221 @end defmac
2222
2223 @node Leaf Functions
2224 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2225
2226 @cindex leaf functions
2227 @cindex functions, leaf
2228 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2229 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2230 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2231 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2232 normally arrive.
2233
2234 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2235 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2236 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2237 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2238 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2239 functions''.
2240
2241 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2242 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2243 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2244 accomplish this.
2245
2246 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2247 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2248 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2249 function treatment.
2250
2251 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2252 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2253 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2254 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2255 in this vector.
2256
2257 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2258 the treatment of leaf functions.
2259 @end defmac
2260
2261 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2262 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2263 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2264
2265 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2266 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2267 will cause the compiler to abort.
2268
2269 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2270 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2271 this.
2272 @end defmac
2273
2274 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2275 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2276 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2277 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2278 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2279 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2280 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2281 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2282 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2283 functions which only use leaf registers.
2284 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2285 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2286 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2287 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2288 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2289
2290 @node Stack Registers
2291 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2292
2293 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2294 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2295 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2296 stack.
2297
2298 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2299 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2300 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2301 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2302 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2303 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2304 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2305
2306 @defmac STACK_REGS
2307 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2308 @end defmac
2309
2310 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2311 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2312 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2316 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2317 of the stack.
2318 @end defmac
2319
2320 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2321 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2322 the stack.
2323 @end defmac
2324
2325 @node Register Classes
2326 @section Register Classes
2327 @cindex register class definitions
2328 @cindex class definitions, register
2329
2330 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2331 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2332 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2333 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2334
2335 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2336 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2337 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2338
2339 @findex ALL_REGS
2340 @findex NO_REGS
2341 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2342 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2343 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2344 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2345
2346 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2347 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2348 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2349 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2350 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2351 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2352
2353 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2354 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2355
2356 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2357 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2358 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2359 them in operand constraints.
2360
2361 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2362 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2363 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2364 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2365 (@pxref{Costs}).
2366
2367 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2368 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2369 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2370 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2371 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2372 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2373 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2374
2375 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2376 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2377 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2378 in their union.
2379
2380 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2381 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2382 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2383 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2384 specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2385
2386 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2387 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2388 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2389 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2390 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2391 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2392 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2393 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2394 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2395
2396 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2397 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2398 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2399 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2400 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2401 tells how many classes there are.
2402
2403 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2404 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2405 in many of the tables described below.
2406 @end deftp
2407
2408 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2409 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2410
2411 @smallexample
2412 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2413 @end smallexample
2414 @end defmac
2415
2416 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2417 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2418 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2419 @end defmac
2420
2421 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2422 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2423 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2424 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2425 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2426
2427 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2428 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2429 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2430 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2431 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2432 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2433 so on.
2434 @end defmac
2435
2436 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2437 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2438 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2439 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2440 register.
2441 @end defmac
2442
2443 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2444 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2445 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2446 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2447 @end defmac
2448
2449 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2450 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2451 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2452 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2453 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2454 @end defmac
2455
2456 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2457 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2458 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2459 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2460 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2461 @end defmac
2462
2463 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2464 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2465 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2466 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2467 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2468 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2469 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2470 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2471 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2472 @end defmac
2473
2474 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2475 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2476 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2477 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2478 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2479 @end defmac
2480
2481 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2482 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2483 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2484 @end defmac
2485
2486 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2487 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2488 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2489 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2490 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2491 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2492 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2493 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2494 @code{address_operand}.
2495 @end defmac
2496
2497 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2498 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2499 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2500 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2501 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2502 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2503 than other base register uses.
2504
2505 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2506 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2507 @end defmac
2508
2509 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2510 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2511 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2512 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2513 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2514 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2515 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2516 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2517 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2518 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2519 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2520 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2521 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2522 @end defmac
2523
2524 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2525 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2526 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2527 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2528 allocated such a hard register.
2529
2530 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2531 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2532 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2533 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2534 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2535 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2536 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2537 only if neither labeling works.
2538 @end defmac
2539
2540 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2541 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2542 @end deftypefn
2543
2544 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2545 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2546 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2547 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2548 another, smaller class.
2549
2550 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2551
2552 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2553 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2554 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2555 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2556 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2557
2558 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2559 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2560 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2561 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2562 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2563 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2564 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2565 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2566 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2567 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2568 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2569
2570 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2571 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2572 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2573 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2574 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2575 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2576 @end deftypefn
2577
2578 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2579 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2580 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2581 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2582 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2583 safe:
2584
2585 @smallexample
2586 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2587 @end smallexample
2588
2589 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2590 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2591 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2592 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2593 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2594
2595 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2596 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2597 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2598 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2599 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2600 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2601 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2602 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded
2603 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2604 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2605 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2606
2607 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2608 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2609 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2610 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2611 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2612 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2613 @end defmac
2614
2615 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2616 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2617 input reloads.
2618
2619 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2620 argument.
2621
2622 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2623 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2624 @end deftypefn
2625
2626 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2627 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2628 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2629 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2630 ordinarily be used.
2631
2632 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2633 there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
2634
2635 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2636 smaller class.
2637
2638 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2639 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2640 @end defmac
2641
2642 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2643 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2644 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2645 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2646 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2647 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2648 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2649 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2650 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2651 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2652 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2653 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2654 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2655
2656 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2657 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2658 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2659 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2660 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2661 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2662 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2663 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2664 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2665 of the scratch register(s).
2666
2667 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2668
2669 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2670 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2671 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2672 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2673 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2674
2675 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2676 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2677 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2678 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2679 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2680 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2681
2682 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2683 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2684 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2685 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2686 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2687
2688 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2689 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2690 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2691 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2692 single-register-class
2693 @c [later: or memory]
2694 output constraint.
2695
2696 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2697 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2698 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2699 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2700
2701 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2702 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2703 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2704 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2705 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2706 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2707 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2708 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2709
2710
2711 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2712 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2713 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2714 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2715
2716 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2717 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2718 to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2719
2720 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2721 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2722 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2723 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2724 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2725 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2726 @end deftypefn
2727
2728 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2729 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2730 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2731 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2732 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2733
2734 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2735 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2736 reload phase that it may
2737 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2738 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2739 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2740 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2741 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2742 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2743
2744 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2745 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2746 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2747 class required. If the
2748 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2749 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2750 macros identically.
2751
2752 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2753 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2754 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2755 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2756 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2757
2758 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2759 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2760 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2761 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2762 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2763 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2764 register.
2765
2766 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2767 register that
2768 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2769 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2770 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2771 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2772 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2773
2774 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2775 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2776 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2777 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2778
2779 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2780 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2781 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2782 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2783 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2784 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2785 general registers.
2786 @end defmac
2787
2788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{class1}, reg_class_t @var{class2})
2789 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2790 to some other registers without using memory. Define this hook on
2791 those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers
2792 of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by
2793 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory
2794 location into a register of @var{class2}. The default definition returns
2795 false for all inputs.
2796 @end deftypefn
2797
2798 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2799 Normally when @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2800 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2801 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2802 defined by this macro.
2803
2804 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2805 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2806 @end defmac
2807
2808 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
2809 If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory
2810 when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode},
2811 this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have.
2812
2813 The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}. Without LRA, the default
2814 is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a
2815 a word. This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures
2816 that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the
2817 registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for
2818 floating-point registers.
2819
2820 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2821 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2822 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2823 widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to
2824 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.c} for
2825 details.
2826
2827 With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified.
2828 @end deftypefn
2829
2830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SELECT_EARLY_REMAT_MODES (sbitmap @var{modes})
2831 On some targets, certain modes cannot be held in registers around a
2832 standard ABI call and are relatively expensive to spill to the stack.
2833 The early rematerialization pass can help in such cases by aggressively
2834 recomputing values after calls, so that they don't need to be spilled.
2835
2836 This hook returns the set of such modes by setting the associated bits
2837 in @var{modes}. The default implementation selects no modes, which has
2838 the effect of disabling the early rematerialization pass.
2839 @end deftypefn
2840
2841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2842 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2843 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2844 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2845
2846 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2847 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2848 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2849 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2850 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2851
2852 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2853 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2854 pressure.
2855 @end deftypefn
2856
2857 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2858 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2859 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2860
2861 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.
2862 In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2863 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2864 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2865 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2866
2867 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2868 in the reload pass.
2869
2870 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2871 in words.
2872 @end deftypefn
2873
2874 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2875 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2876 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2877
2878 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2879 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2880 should be the maximum value of @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2881 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2882
2883 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2884 in the reload pass.
2885 @end defmac
2886
2887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (machine_mode @var{from}, machine_mode @var{to}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2888 This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in
2889 registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to}
2890 and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes.
2891 The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold
2892 both @code{from} and @code{to}. The default implementation returns true.
2893
2894 As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or
2895 floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them
2896 to 64 bits. Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a
2897 32-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case
2898 for a normal register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines
2899 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return:
2900
2901 @smallexample
2902 (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to)
2903 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass))
2904 @end smallexample
2905
2906 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2907 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider
2908 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2909 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2910 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2911 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2912 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2913 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2914 value that the middle-end intended.
2915 @end deftypefn
2916
2917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2918 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2919 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2920
2921 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2922 @end deftypefn
2923
2924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2925 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2926 @end deftypefn
2927
2928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2929 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2930 @end deftypefn
2931
2932 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2933 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2934 @end deftypefn
2935
2936 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2937 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2938 @end deftypefn
2939
2940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2941 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2942 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2943 register allocation.
2944 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2945 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2946 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2947 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2948 @end deftypefn
2949
2950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{offset1}, rtx *@var{offset2}, poly_int64 @var{orig_offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2951 This hook tries to split address offset @var{orig_offset} into
2952 two parts: one that should be added to the base address to create
2953 a local anchor point, and an additional offset that can be applied
2954 to the anchor to address a value of mode @var{mode}. The idea is that
2955 the local anchor could be shared by other accesses to nearby locations.
2956
2957 The hook returns true if it succeeds, storing the offset of the
2958 anchor from the base in @var{offset1} and the offset of the final address
2959 from the anchor in @var{offset2}. The default implementation returns false.
2960 @end deftypefn
2961
2962 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2963 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2964 @end deftypefn
2965
2966 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2967 This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2968 @end deftypefn
2969
2970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2971 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2972 @end deftypefn
2973
2974 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2975 A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2976 @end deftypefn
2977
2978 @node Stack and Calling
2979 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2980 @cindex calling conventions
2981
2982 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2983 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2984
2985 @menu
2986 * Frame Layout::
2987 * Exception Handling::
2988 * Stack Checking::
2989 * Frame Registers::
2990 * Elimination::
2991 * Stack Arguments::
2992 * Register Arguments::
2993 * Scalar Return::
2994 * Aggregate Return::
2995 * Caller Saves::
2996 * Function Entry::
2997 * Profiling::
2998 * Tail Calls::
2999 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
3000 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3001 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
3002 @end menu
3003
3004 @node Frame Layout
3005 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3006 @cindex stack frame layout
3007 @cindex frame layout
3008
3009 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3010 Here is the basic stack layout.
3011
3012 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3013 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3014 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
3015 @end defmac
3016
3017 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3018 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3019 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3020 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3021
3022 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3023 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3024 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3025 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3026 space for the next item on the stack.
3027
3028 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3029 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3030 which is often wrong.
3031 @end defmac
3032
3033 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3034 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3035 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3036 @end defmac
3037
3038 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3039 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3040 addresses on the stack.
3041 @end defmac
3042
3043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET (void)
3044 This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local
3045 variable slot to be allocated. If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the
3046 offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the
3047 offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated. The default
3048 implementation returns 0.
3049 @end deftypefn
3050
3051 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3052 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3053 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3054
3055 On ports where @code{TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3056 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3057 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3058 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3059 @end defmac
3060
3061 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3062 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3063 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3064 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3065
3066 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3067 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3068 @end defmac
3069
3070 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3071 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3072 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3073 function.
3074
3075 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3076 the first argument's address.
3077 @end defmac
3078
3079 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3080 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3081 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3082
3083 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3084 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3085 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3086 @end defmac
3087
3088 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3089 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3090 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3091 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3092 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3093 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3094 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3095 @end defmac
3096
3097 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3098 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3099 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3100 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3101 itself.
3102
3103 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3104 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3105 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3106 @end defmac
3107
3108 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3109 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3110 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3111 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3112 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3113 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3114 @end defmac
3115
3116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3117 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3118 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3119 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3120 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3121 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3122 @end deftypefn
3123
3124 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3125 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3126 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3127 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3128 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3129 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3130 @end defmac
3131
3132 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3133 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3134 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3135 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3136 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3137 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3138
3139 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3140 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3141 determine the return address of other frames.
3142 @end defmac
3143
3144 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3145 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3146 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3147 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3148 @end defmac
3149
3150 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3151 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3152 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3153 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3154 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3155 the stack.
3156
3157 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3158 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3159
3160 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3161 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3162 @end defmac
3163
3164 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3165 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3166 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3167 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3168 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3169
3170 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3171 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3172 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3173 over time.
3174 @end defmac
3175
3176 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3177 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3178 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3179 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3180 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3181 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3182 @end defmac
3183
3184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3185 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3186 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3187 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3188 @smallexample
3189 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3190 @end smallexample
3191 and
3192 @smallexample
3193 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3194 @end smallexample
3195 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3196 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3197 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3198 @end deftypefn
3199
3200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_DWARF_POLY_INDETERMINATE_VALUE (unsigned int @var{i}, unsigned int *@var{factor}, int *@var{offset})
3201 Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF
3202 expression, with @var{i} counting from 1. Return the number of a DWARF
3203 register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such
3204 that the value of the indeterminate is:
3205 @smallexample
3206 value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset}
3207 @end smallexample
3208
3209 A target only needs to define this hook if it sets
3210 @samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1.
3211 @end deftypefn
3212
3213 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3214 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3215 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3216 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3217 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3218 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3219
3220 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3221 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3222 @end defmac
3223
3224 @defmac DEFAULT_INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3225 Like @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}, but must be the same for all
3226 functions of the same ABI, and when using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives
3227 must also agree with the default CFI GAS emits. Define this macro
3228 only if @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} can have different values
3229 between different functions of the same ABI or when
3230 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} does not agree with GAS default CFI.
3231 @end defmac
3232
3233 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3234 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3235 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3236 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3237 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3238 during virtual register instantiation.
3239
3240 The default value for this macro is
3241 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3242 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3243 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3244 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3245 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3246
3247 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3248 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3249 DWARF 2.
3250 @end defmac
3251
3252 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3253 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3254 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3255 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3256 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3257
3258 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3259 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3260 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3261 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3262 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3263 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3264 should be defined.
3265 @end defmac
3266
3267 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3268 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3269 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3270 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3271 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3272 @end defmac
3273
3274 @node Exception Handling
3275 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3276 @cindex exception handling
3277
3278 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3279 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3280 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3281 @var{N} registers are usable.
3282
3283 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3284 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3285 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3286 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3287 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3288
3289 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3290 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3291 @end defmac
3292
3293 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3294 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3295 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3296 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3297 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3298
3299 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3300 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3301
3302 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3303 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3304 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3305 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3306 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3307 that provided by DWARF 2.
3308 @end defmac
3309
3310 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3311 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3312 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3313 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3314
3315 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3316 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3317 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3318 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3319 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3320 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3321 target call frame.
3322
3323 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3324 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3325 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3326
3327 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3328 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3329 @end defmac
3330
3331 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3332 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3333 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3334 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3335 using it to return to the exception handler.
3336 @end defmac
3337
3338 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3339 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3340 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3341 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3342 and so may be read-only.
3343
3344 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3345 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3346 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3347 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3348
3349 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3350 represented directly.
3351 @end defmac
3352
3353 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3354 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3355 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3356 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3357 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3358
3359 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3360 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3361 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3362 to be emitted.
3363 @end defmac
3364
3365 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3366 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3367 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3368 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3369 through signal frames.
3370
3371 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3372 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3373 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3374 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3375 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3376 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3377 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3378 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3379 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3380
3381 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3382 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3383 @end defmac
3384
3385 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3386 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3387 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3388 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3389
3390 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3391 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3392 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3393 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3394 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3395 be updated in @var{fs}.
3396 @end defmac
3397
3398 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3399 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3400 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3401 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3402 @end defmac
3403
3404 @node Stack Checking
3405 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3406
3407 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3408 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3409 three ways:
3410
3411 @enumerate
3412 @item
3413 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3414 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3415 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3416 other special processing.
3417
3418 @item
3419 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3420 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3421 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3422 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3423 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3424 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3425 approach below.
3426
3427 @item
3428 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3429 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3430 @end enumerate
3431
3432 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3433 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3434 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3435 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3436
3437 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3438 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3439 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3440 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3441 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3442 value of this macro is zero.
3443 @end defmac
3444
3445 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3446 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3447 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3448 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3449 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3450 @end defmac
3451
3452 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3453 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3454 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3455 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3456 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3457 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3458 @end defmac
3459
3460 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3461 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3462 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3463 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3464 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3465 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3466 default value of this macro is zero.
3467 @end defmac
3468
3469 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3470 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3471 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3472 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3473 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3474 architectures and operating systems.
3475 @end defmac
3476
3477 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3478 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3479 in the opposite case.
3480
3481 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3482 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3483 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3484 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3485 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3486 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3487 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3488 @end defmac
3489
3490 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3491 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3492 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3493 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3494 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3495 use the default of four words.
3496 @end defmac
3497
3498 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3499 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3500 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3501 @option{-fstack-check}.
3502 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3503 normally not need to override that default.
3504 @end defmac
3505
3506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STACK_CLASH_PROTECTION_ALLOCA_PROBE_RANGE (void)
3507 Some targets have an ABI defined interval for which no probing needs to be done.
3508 When a probe does need to be done this same interval is used as the probe distance up when doing stack clash protection for alloca.
3509 On such targets this value can be set to override the default probing up interval.
3510 Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe range is required or zero otherwise. Defining this hook also requires your functions which make use of alloca to have at least 8 byesof outgoing arguments. If this is not the case the stack will be corrupted.
3511 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero.
3512 @end deftypefn
3513
3514 @need 2000
3515 @node Frame Registers
3516 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3517
3518 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3519 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3520
3521 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3522 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3523 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3524 the hardware determines which register this is.
3525 @end defmac
3526
3527 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3528 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3529 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3530 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3531 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3532 @end defmac
3533
3534 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3535 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3536 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3537 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3538 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3539 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3540 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3541 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3542 used for the frame pointer.
3543
3544 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3545 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3546 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3547 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3548 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3549 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3550 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3551
3552 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3553 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3554 @end defmac
3555
3556 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3557 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3558 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3559 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3560 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3561 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3562 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3563 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3564 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3565 @end defmac
3566
3567 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3568 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3569 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3570 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3571 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3572 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3573 @end defmac
3574
3575 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3576 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3577 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3578 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3579 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3580 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3581 @end defmac
3582
3583 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3584 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3585 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3586 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3587 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3588 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3589 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3590
3591 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3592 address from the stack.
3593 @end defmac
3594
3595 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3596 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3597 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3598 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3599 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3600 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3601 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3602 not be defined.
3603
3604 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3605
3606 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3607 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3608 @end defmac
3609
3610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3611 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3612 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3613 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3614 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3615 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3616
3617 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3618
3619 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3620 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3621 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3622 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3623 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3624 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3625 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3626 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3627 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3628 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3629 to refer to those items.
3630 @end deftypefn
3631
3632 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3633 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3634 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3635 DWARF2 exception handling.
3636
3637 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3638 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3639 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3640 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3641 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3642 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3643 registers that are not call-saved.
3644
3645 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3646 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3647 @end defmac
3648
3649 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3650
3651 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3652 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3653
3654 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3655 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3656 @end defmac
3657
3658 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3659
3660 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3661 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3662 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3663 column number to use instead.
3664 @end defmac
3665
3666 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3667
3668 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3669 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3670 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3671 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3672 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3673
3674 @end defmac
3675
3676 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3677
3678 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3679 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3680 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3681 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3682 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3683
3684 @end defmac
3685
3686 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3687
3688 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3689 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3690 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3691 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3692
3693 @end defmac
3694
3695 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3696
3697 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3698 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3699 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3700 defined and 0 otherwise.
3701
3702 @end defmac
3703
3704 @defmac DWARF_LAZY_REGISTER_VALUE (@var{regno}, @var{value})
3705 Define this macro if the target has pseudo DWARF registers whose
3706 values need to be computed lazily on demand by the unwinder (such as when
3707 referenced in a CFA expression). The macro returns true if @var{regno}
3708 is such a register and stores its value in @samp{*@var{value}} if so.
3709 @end defmac
3710
3711 @node Elimination
3712 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3713
3714 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3715 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3716
3717 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3718 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3719 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3720 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3721
3722 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3723 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3724 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3725 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3726 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3727 pointer.
3728
3729 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3730 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3731 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3732 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3733 them.
3734
3735 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3736 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3737 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3738
3739 Default return value is @code{false}.
3740 @end deftypefn
3741
3742 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3743 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3744 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3745
3746 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3747 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3748
3749 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3750 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3751 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3752 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3753 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3754
3755 In this case, you might specify:
3756 @smallexample
3757 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3758 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3759 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3760 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3761 @end smallexample
3762
3763 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3764 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3765 @end defmac
3766
3767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3768 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3769 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3770 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3771 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3772 knows about.
3773
3774 Default return value is @code{true}.
3775 @end deftypefn
3776
3777 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3778 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3779 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3780 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3781 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3782 @end defmac
3783
3784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3785 This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3786 recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3787 be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3788 layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful
3789 for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing
3790 this callback is optional.
3791 @end deftypefn
3792
3793 @node Stack Arguments
3794 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3795 @cindex arguments on stack
3796 @cindex stack arguments
3797
3798 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3799 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3800 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3801
3802 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3803 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3804 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3805 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3806 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3807 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3808 @end deftypefn
3809
3810 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3811 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3812 outgoing arguments.
3813 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3814 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3815 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3816 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3817 @end defmac
3818
3819 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3820 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3821 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3822 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3823 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3824 @end defmac
3825
3826 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3827 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3828 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3829
3830 On some machines, the definition
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 @noindent
3837 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3838 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3839 alignment. Then the definition should be
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3843 @end smallexample
3844
3845 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3846 @end defmac
3847
3848 @findex outgoing_args_size
3849 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3850 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3851 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3852 will be computed and placed into
3853 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3854 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3855 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3856
3857 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3858 is not proper.
3859 @end defmac
3860
3861 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3862 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3863 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3864 registers.
3865
3866 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3867 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3868 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3869 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3870 of the function.
3871
3872 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3873 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3874 which.
3875 @end defmac
3876 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3877 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3878
3879 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3880 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3881 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3882 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3883 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3884 @end defmac
3885
3886 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3887 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3888 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3889 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3890 if the function called is a library function.
3891
3892 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3893 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3894 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3895 @end defmac
3896
3897 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3898 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3899 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3900 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3901 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3902
3903 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3904 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3905 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3906 stack in its natural location.
3907 @end defmac
3908
3909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_int64 TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, poly_int64 @var{size})
3910 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3911 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3912 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3913
3914 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3915 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3916 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3917 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3918
3919 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3920 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3921 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3922 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3923 arguments (if known).
3924
3925 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3926 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3927 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3928 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3929 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3930 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3931
3932 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3933 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3934 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3935
3936 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3937 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3938 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3939 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3940 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3941 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3942 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3943 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3944 number of arguments.
3945 @end deftypefn
3946
3947 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3948 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3949 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3950 when compiling a function call.
3951
3952 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3953 have been accumulated.
3954
3955 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3956 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3957 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3958 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3959 appropriate.
3960 @end defmac
3961
3962 @node Register Arguments
3963 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3964 @cindex arguments in registers
3965 @cindex registers arguments
3966
3967 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3968 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3969 the stack.
3970
3971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
3972 Return an RTX indicating whether function argument @var{arg} is passed
3973 in a register and if so, which register. Argument @var{ca} summarizes all
3974 the previous arguments.
3975
3976 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3977 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3978 on the stack.
3979
3980 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3981 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3982 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3983 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3984 for more information.
3985
3986 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3987 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3988 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3989 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3990 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3991 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3992 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3993 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3994 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3995 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3996 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3997 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3998 argument is also stored on the stack.
3999
4000 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4001 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4002 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4003
4004 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4005 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4006 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4007 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4008 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4009 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4010
4011 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4012 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4013 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4014 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4015 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4016 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4017 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4018 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4019 a register.
4020 @end deftypefn
4021
4022 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4023 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{arg}
4024 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4025 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4026 documentation.
4027 @end deftypefn
4028
4029 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4030 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
4031 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
4032 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
4033 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
4034
4035 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4036 which the caller passes the value, and
4037 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4038 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4039 arrive.
4040
4041 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
4042 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
4043 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
4044
4045 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4046 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4047 @end deftypefn
4048
4049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
4050 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
4051 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
4052 @end deftypefn
4053
4054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
4055 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
4056 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
4057 @end deftypefn
4058
4059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4060 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4061 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4062 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4063 pushed on the stack.
4064
4065 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4066 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4067 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4068 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4069 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4070 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4071 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4072
4073 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4074 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4075 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4076 @end deftypefn
4077
4078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4079 This target hook should return @code{true} if argument @var{arg} at the
4080 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4081 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4082 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (@var{arg}.type)}.
4083
4084 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4085 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4086 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4087 to that type.
4088 @end deftypefn
4089
4090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4091 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4092 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4093 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4094 by the caller.
4095
4096 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4097 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4098 not be generated.
4099
4100 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4101 @end deftypefn
4102
4103 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4104 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4105 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4106 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4107 of bytes of argument so far.
4108
4109 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4110 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4111 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4112 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4113 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4114 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4115 @end defmac
4116
4117 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4118 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4119 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4120 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4121 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4122 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4123 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4124 @end defmac
4125
4126 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4127 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4128 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4129 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4130 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4131 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4132 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4133 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4134 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4135 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4136 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4137 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4138 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4139
4140 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4141 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4142 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4143 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4144 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4145 never both of them at once.
4146 @end defmac
4147
4148 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4149 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4150 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4151 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4152 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4153 0)} is used instead.
4154 @end defmac
4155
4156 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4157 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4158 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4159 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4160
4161 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4162 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4163 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4164 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4165 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4166 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4167 @end defmac
4168
4169 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4170 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4171 advance past argument @var{arg} in the argument list. Once this is done,
4172 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4173 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4174
4175 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4176 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4177 used for arguments without any special help.
4178 @end deftypefn
4179
4180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4181 This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an
4182 argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory.
4183 This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short}
4184 arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word
4185 instead of starting at the top. The default implementation returns 0.
4186 @end deftypefn
4187
4188 @deftypefn {Target Hook} pad_direction TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4189 This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out
4190 an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}. It returns
4191 @code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD}
4192 to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding.
4193
4194 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by
4195 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is always just enough
4196 to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4197
4198 This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems.
4199 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4200 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4201 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4202 @end deftypefn
4203
4204 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4205 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4206 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4207 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4208 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4209 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4210 @end defmac
4211
4212 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4213 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4214 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4215 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4216 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4217 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4218 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4219 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4220 required.
4221 @end defmac
4222
4223 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4224 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4225 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4226 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4227 @end deftypefn
4228
4229 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4230 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4231 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4232 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4233 value.
4234 @end deftypefn
4235
4236 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4237 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4238 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4239 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4240 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4241 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4242 stack.
4243 @end defmac
4244
4245 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4246 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4247 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4248 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4249 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4250 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4251 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4252 point register.
4253
4254 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4255 false.
4256 @end deftypefn
4257
4258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4259 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4260 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4261 @end deftypefn
4262
4263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4264 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4265 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4266 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4267 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4268 variable.
4269 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4270 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4271 internal type.
4272 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4273 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4274 macro to iterate through all types.
4275 @end deftypefn
4276
4277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4278 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4279 @var{fndecl}.
4280 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4281 @end deftypefn
4282
4283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4284 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4285 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4286 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4287 @end deftypefn
4288
4289 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4290 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4291 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4292 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4293 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4294 @end deftypefn
4295
4296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode})
4297 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4298 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4299 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4300 @end deftypefn
4301
4302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (ao_ref *@var{ref})
4303 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4304 @end deftypefn
4305
4306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_TRANSLATE_MODE_ATTRIBUTE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4307 Define this hook if during mode attribute processing, the port should
4308 translate machine_mode @var{mode} to another mode. For example, rs6000's
4309 @code{KFmode}, when it is the same as @code{TFmode}.
4310
4311 The default version of the hook returns that mode that was passed in.
4312 @end deftypefn
4313
4314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode})
4315 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4316 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4317 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4318 must work.
4319
4320 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4321 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4322 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4323 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4324 @end deftypefn
4325
4326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4327 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4328 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4329 must have move patterns for this mode.
4330 @end deftypefn
4331
4332 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMPATIBLE_VECTOR_TYPES_P (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4333 Return true if there is no target-specific reason for treating
4334 vector types @var{type1} and @var{type2} as distinct types. The caller
4335 has already checked for target-independent reasons, meaning that the
4336 types are known to have the same mode, to have the same number of elements,
4337 and to have what the caller considers to be compatible element types.
4338
4339 The main reason for defining this hook is to reject pairs of types
4340 that are handled differently by the target's calling convention.
4341 For example, when a new @var{N}-bit vector architecture is added
4342 to a target, the target may want to handle normal @var{N}-bit
4343 @code{VECTOR_TYPE} arguments and return values in the same way as
4344 before, to maintain backwards compatibility. However, it may also
4345 provide new, architecture-specific @code{VECTOR_TYPE}s that are passed
4346 and returned in a more efficient way. It is then important to maintain
4347 a distinction between the ``normal'' @code{VECTOR_TYPE}s and the new
4348 architecture-specific ones.
4349
4350 The default implementation returns true, which is correct for most targets.
4351 @end deftypefn
4352
4353 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_ARRAY_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4354 Return the mode that GCC should use for an array that has
4355 @var{nelems} elements, with each element having mode @var{mode}.
4356 Return no mode if the target has no special requirements. In the
4357 latter case, GCC looks for an integer mode of the appropriate size
4358 if available and uses BLKmode otherwise. Usually the search for the
4359 integer mode is limited to @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE}, but the
4360 @code{TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} hook allows a larger mode to be
4361 used in specific cases.
4362
4363 The main use of this hook is to specify that an array of vectors should
4364 also have a vector mode. The default implementation returns no mode.
4365 @end deftypefn
4366
4367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4368 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4369 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4370 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4371 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4372
4373 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4374 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4375 has operations like:
4376
4377 @smallexample
4378 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4379 @end smallexample
4380
4381 where the return type is defined as:
4382
4383 @smallexample
4384 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4385 @{
4386 int8x8_t val[3];
4387 @} int8x8x3_t;
4388 @end smallexample
4389
4390 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4391 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4392 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4393 @end deftypefn
4394
4395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode})
4396 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4397 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4398 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4399 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4400 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4401 @end deftypefn
4402
4403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4404 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4405 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4406 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not
4407 supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of
4408 this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4409 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4410 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4411 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4412 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4413 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4414 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4415 @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values
4416 of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to
4417 ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,
4418 if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4419 @end deftypefn
4420
4421 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOATN_BUILTIN_P (int @var{func})
4422 Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and
4423 @code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the
4424 built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the
4425 normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix. The default is
4426 to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for
4427 the GNU C langauge. In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without
4428 the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled. The argument @code{FUNC} is the
4429 @code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled.
4430 @end deftypefn
4431
4432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4433 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4434 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4435 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4436 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4437 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4438 for any mode.
4439
4440 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4441 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4442 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4443 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4444 insn.
4445
4446 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4447 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4448 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4449 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4450 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4451 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4452 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4453 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4454 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4455
4456 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4457 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4458 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4459 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4460 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4461 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4462 @end deftypefn
4463
4464 @node Scalar Return
4465 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4466 @cindex return values in registers
4467 @cindex values, returned by functions
4468 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4469
4470 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4471 values---values that can fit in registers.
4472
4473 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4474
4475 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4476 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4477 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4478 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4479 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4480 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4481 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4482 a function returns a value.
4483
4484 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4485 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4486 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4487 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4488 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4489 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4490 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4491 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4492 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4493 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4494 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4495 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4496
4497 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4498 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4499 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4500
4501 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4502 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4503 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4504 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4505 known.
4506
4507 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4508 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4509 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4510 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4511
4512 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4513 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4514 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4515 @end deftypefn
4516
4517 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4518 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4519 a new target instead.
4520 @end defmac
4521
4522 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4523 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4524 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4525
4526 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4527 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4528 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4529 compiled.
4530 @end defmac
4531
4532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4533 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4534 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4535
4536 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4537 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4538 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4539
4540 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4541 @end deftypefn
4542
4543 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4544 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4545 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4546
4547 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4548 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4549 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4550 suffices:
4551
4552 @smallexample
4553 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4554 @end smallexample
4555
4556 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4557 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4558 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4559
4560 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4561 for a new target instead.
4562 @end defmac
4563
4564 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4565 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4566 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4567
4568 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4569 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4570 recognized by this target hook.
4571
4572 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4573 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4574 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4575
4576 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4577 @end deftypefn
4578
4579 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4580 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4581 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4582 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4583 @end defmac
4584
4585 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4586 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4587 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4588 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4589 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4590 undesirable on your target.
4591 @end deftypevr
4592
4593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4594 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4595 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4596 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4597 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4598
4599 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4600 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4601 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4602 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4603 @code{SImode} rtx.
4604 @end deftypefn
4605
4606 @node Aggregate Return
4607 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4608 @cindex aggregates as return values
4609 @cindex large return values
4610 @cindex returning aggregate values
4611 @cindex structure value address
4612
4613 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4614 cases), the value is not returned according to
4615 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4616 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4617 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4618 address}.
4619
4620 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4621 memory.
4622
4623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4624 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4625 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4626 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4627 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4628 libcalls.
4629
4630 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4631 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4632 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4633 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4634 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4635 values, and 0 otherwise.
4636
4637 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4638 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4639 to indicate this.
4640 @end deftypefn
4641
4642 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4643 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4644 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4645 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4646 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4647 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4648 target hook.
4649
4650 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4651 @end defmac
4652
4653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4654 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4655 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4656 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4657 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4658 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4659 argument.
4660
4661 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4662 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4663 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4664 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4665 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4666 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4667 the caller.
4668
4669 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4670 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4671 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4672 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4673 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4674 @end deftypefn
4675
4676 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4677 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4678 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4679 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4680
4681 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4682 pass an address to the subroutine.
4683
4684 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4685 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4686 @end defmac
4687
4688 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4689 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4690 @end deftypefn
4691
4692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4693 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4694 @end deftypefn
4695
4696 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMPTY_RECORD_P (const_tree @var{type})
4697 This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record. The default
4698 is to return @code{false}.
4699 @end deftypefn
4700
4701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_WARN_PARAMETER_PASSING_ABI (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, tree @var{type})
4702 This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing
4703 ABI.
4704 @end deftypefn
4705
4706 @node Caller Saves
4707 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4708
4709 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4710 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4711 must live across calls.
4712
4713 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4714 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4715 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4716 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4717 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4718 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4719 @end defmac
4720
4721 @node Function Entry
4722 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4723 @cindex function entry and exit
4724 @cindex prologue
4725 @cindex epilogue
4726
4727 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4728 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4729
4730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p})
4731 Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of
4732 @var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named
4733 sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current
4734 location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation
4735 of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named
4736 @code{__patchable_function_entries}.
4737 @end deftypefn
4738
4739 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4740 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4741 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4742 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4743 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4744 local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler
4745 code should be output.
4746
4747 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4748 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4749
4750 @findex regs_ever_live
4751 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4752 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4753 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4754 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4755 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4756 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4757
4758 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4759 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4760 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4761 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4762 registers are used in the function.
4763
4764 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4765 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4766 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4767 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4768 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4769 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4770 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4771
4772 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4773 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4774 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4775 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4776 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4777 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4778 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4779 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4780 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4781 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4782 @end deftypefn
4783
4784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4785 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4786 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4787 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4788 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4789 @end deftypefn
4790
4791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4792 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4793 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4794 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4795 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4796 @end deftypefn
4797
4798 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4799 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4800 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4801 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4802 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4803 same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4804 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4805 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4806
4807 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4808 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4809 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4810 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4811
4812 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4813 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4814 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4815 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4816 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4817 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4818
4819 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4820 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4821 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4822 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4823 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4824 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4825
4826 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4827 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4828 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4829 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4830
4831 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4832 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4833 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4834 number of arguments.
4835
4836 @findex pops_args
4837 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4838 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4839 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4840 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4841 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4842 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4843 @end deftypefn
4844
4845 @itemize @bullet
4846 @item
4847 @findex pretend_args_size
4848 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4849 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4850 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4851 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4852 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4853 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4854 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4855 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4856 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4857 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4858
4859 @item
4860 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4861 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4862 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4863 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4864 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4865 a save area.
4866
4867 @item
4868 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4869 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4870 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4871 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4872
4873 @item
4874 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4875 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4876 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4877 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4878 @end itemize
4879
4880 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4881 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4882 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4883 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4884 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4885 default is 0.
4886
4887 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4888 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4889 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4890 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4891 @end defmac
4892
4893 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4894 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4895 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4896 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4897 @end defmac
4898
4899 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4900 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4901 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4902 on entry to an exception edge.
4903 @end defmac
4904
4905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4906 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4907 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4908 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4909 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4910 the real function.
4911
4912 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4913 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4914 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4915 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4916 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4917 all other incoming arguments.
4918
4919 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4920 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4921 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4922
4923 @smallexample
4924 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4925 @end smallexample
4926
4927 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4928 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4929 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4930 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4931
4932 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4933 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4934 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4935 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4936
4937 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4938 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4939 some targets, but probably not.
4940
4941 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4942 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4943 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4944 not support varargs.
4945 @end deftypefn
4946
4947 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4948 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4949 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4950 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4951 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4952 previously exposed.
4953 @end deftypefn
4954
4955 @node Profiling
4956 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4957 @cindex profiling, code generation
4958
4959 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4960
4961 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4962 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4963 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4964
4965 @findex mcount
4966 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4967 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4968 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4969 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4970
4971 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4972 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4973 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4974 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4975 @end defmac
4976
4977 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4978 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4979 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4980 not support profiling.
4981 @end defmac
4982
4983 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4984 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4985 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4986 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4987 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4988 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4989 @end defmac
4990
4991 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4992 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4993 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4994 @end defmac
4995
4996 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4997 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4998 @end deftypefn
4999
5000 @node Tail Calls
5001 @subsection Permitting tail calls
5002 @cindex tail calls
5003
5004 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
5005 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
5006 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
5007 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
5008
5009 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
5010 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
5011 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
5012 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern cannot fail, or fall over to a
5013 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
5014 may vary greatly between different architectures.
5015 @end deftypefn
5016
5017 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
5018 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
5019 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
5020 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
5021 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
5022 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
5023 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
5024 @end deftypefn
5025
5026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
5027 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
5028 @end deftypefn
5029
5030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
5031 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
5032 @end deftypefn
5033
5034 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
5035 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
5036 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
5037
5038 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
5039 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
5040 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
5041 up the static chain, etc.
5042
5043 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
5044 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
5045 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
5046 independent parts of GCC.
5047
5048 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
5049 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
5050 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
5051 paths where this would unnecessary.
5052
5053 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
5054 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
5055 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
5056 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
5057 generic code.
5058
5059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
5060 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5061 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
5062 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
5063 shrink-wrapping.
5064 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
5065 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
5066 @end deftypefn
5067
5068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
5069 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5070 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
5071 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
5072 @end deftypefn
5073
5074 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
5075 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
5076 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
5077 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
5078 epilogue instead.
5079 @end deftypefn
5080
5081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5082 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5083 @end deftypefn
5084
5085 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5086 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5087 @end deftypefn
5088
5089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5090 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
5091 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
5092 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
5093 will be deleted after this call.
5094 @end deftypefn
5095
5096 @node Stack Smashing Protection
5097 @subsection Stack smashing protection
5098 @cindex stack smashing protection
5099
5100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5101 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
5102 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
5103 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5104 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5105 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5106
5107 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5108 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5109 @end deftypefn
5110
5111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5112 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5113 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5114 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5115
5116 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5117 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5118 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5119 @end deftypefn
5120
5121 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
5122 Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
5123 @end deftypefn
5124
5125 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5126 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5127 @end deftypefn
5128
5129 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {vec<const char *>} TARGET_GET_VALID_OPTION_VALUES (int @var{option_code}, const char *@var{prefix})
5130 The hook is used for options that have a non-trivial list of possible option values. OPTION_CODE is option code of opt_code enum type. PREFIX is used for bash completion and allows an implementation to return more specific completion based on the prefix. All string values should be allocated from heap memory and consumers should release them. The result will be pruned to cases with PREFIX if not NULL.
5131 @end deftypefn
5132
5133 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
5134 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
5135 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
5136
5137 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
5138 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
5139 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
5140 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
5141 linker (e.g.@: stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
5142 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
5143 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
5144 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
5145 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
5146 @end deftypevr
5147
5148 @node Varargs
5149 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5150 @cindex varargs implementation
5151
5152 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5153 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5154 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5155 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5156 conditionals to include it.
5157
5158 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5159 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5160 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5161 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5162 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5163 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5164
5165 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5166 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5167 below.
5168
5169 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5170 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5171 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5172 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5173 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5174
5175 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5176 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5177 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5178 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5179
5180 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5181 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5182 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5183 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5184 to use them for its own purposes.
5185 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5186 @c 10feb93
5187 @end defmac
5188
5189 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5190 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5191 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5192 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5193 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5194 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5195 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5196 of the current function.
5197 @end defmac
5198
5199 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5200 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5201 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5202 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5203 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5204 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5205
5206 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5207 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5208 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5209
5210 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5211 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5212 @end defmac
5213
5214 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5215
5216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5217 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5218 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5219 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5220 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5221 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5222 @end deftypefn
5223
5224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5225 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5226 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5227 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5228 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5229 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5230 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5231 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5232
5233 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5234 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5235 named arguments. The argument @var{arg} describes the last of these named
5236 arguments.
5237
5238 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5239 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5240 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5241 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5242 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5243 frame.
5244
5245 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5246 compile time without knowing their data types,
5247 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5248 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5249 for all data types.
5250
5251 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5252 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5253 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5254 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5255 not generate any instructions in this case.
5256 @end deftypefn
5257
5258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5259 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5260 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5261
5262 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5263 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5264 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5265 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5266 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5267 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5268 except the last are treated as named.
5269
5270 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5271 @end deftypefn
5272
5273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5274 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5275 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5276 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5277 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5278 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5279 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5280 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5281 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5282 registers if a target needs it.
5283 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5284 passed instead of an argument register.
5285 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5286 @end deftypefn
5287
5288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5289 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5290 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5291 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5292 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5293 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5294 @end deftypefn
5295
5296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5297 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5298 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5299 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5300 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5301 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5302 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5303 @end deftypefn
5304
5305 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5306 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5307 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5308 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5309 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5310 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5311 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5312 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5313 @end deftypefn
5314
5315 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5316 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5317 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5318 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5319 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5320 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5321 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5322 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5323 @end deftypefn
5324
5325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5326 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5327 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5328 loaded bounds.
5329 @end deftypefn
5330
5331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5332 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5333 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5334 @end deftypefn
5335
5336 @node Trampolines
5337 @section Support for Nested Functions
5338 @cindex support for nested functions
5339 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5340 @cindex descriptors for nested functions
5341 @cindex nested functions, support for
5342
5343 Taking the address of a nested function requires special compiler
5344 handling to ensure that the static chain register is loaded when
5345 the function is invoked via an indirect call.
5346
5347 GCC has traditionally supported nested functions by creating an
5348 executable @dfn{trampoline} at run time when the address of a nested
5349 function is taken. This is a small piece of code which normally
5350 resides on the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.
5351 The trampoline loads the static chain register and then jumps to the
5352 real address of the nested function.
5353
5354 The use of trampolines requires an executable stack, which is a
5355 security risk. To avoid this problem, GCC also supports another
5356 strategy: using descriptors for nested functions. Under this model,
5357 taking the address of a nested function results in a pointer to a
5358 non-executable function descriptor object. Initializing the static chain
5359 from the descriptor is handled at indirect call sites.
5360
5361 On some targets, including HPPA and IA-64, function descriptors may be
5362 mandated by the ABI or be otherwise handled in a target-specific way
5363 by the back end in its code generation strategy for indirect calls.
5364 GCC also provides its own generic descriptor implementation to support the
5365 @option{-fno-trampolines} option. In this case runtime detection of
5366 function descriptors at indirect call sites relies on descriptor
5367 pointers being tagged with a bit that is never set in bare function
5368 addresses. Since GCC's generic function descriptors are
5369 not ABI-compliant, this option is typically used only on a
5370 per-language basis (notably by Ada) or when it can otherwise be
5371 applied to the whole program.
5372
5373 Define the following hook if your backend either implements ABI-specified
5374 descriptor support, or can use GCC's generic descriptor implementation
5375 for nested functions.
5376
5377 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5378 If the target can use GCC's generic descriptor mechanism for nested
5379 functions, define this hook to a power of 2 representing an unused bit
5380 in function pointers which can be used to differentiate descriptors at
5381 run time. This value gives the number of bytes by which descriptor
5382 pointers are misaligned compared to function pointers. For example, on
5383 targets that require functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary, a
5384 value of either 1 or 2 is appropriate unless the architecture already
5385 reserves the bit for another purpose, such as on ARM.
5386
5387 Define this hook to 0 if the target implements ABI support for
5388 function descriptors in its standard calling sequence, like for example
5389 HPPA or IA-64.
5390
5391 Using descriptors for nested functions
5392 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5393 it to be made executable.
5394 @end deftypevr
5395
5396 The following macros tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and
5397 initialize an executable trampoline. You can also use this interface
5398 if your back end needs to create ABI-specified non-executable descriptors; in
5399 this case the "trampoline" created is the descriptor containing data only.
5400
5401 The instructions in an executable trampoline must do two things: load
5402 a constant address into the static chain register, and jump to the real
5403 address of the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k,
5404 this requires two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the
5405 two addresses exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.
5406 On RISC machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a
5407 register in two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate
5408 immediate operands.
5409
5410 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5411 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5412 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5413 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5414 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5415 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5416 separately.
5417
5418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5419 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5420 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5421 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5422 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5423
5424 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5425 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5426 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5427 to generate it on the spot.
5428 @end deftypefn
5429
5430 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5431 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5432 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5433 @end defmac
5434
5435 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5436 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5437 @end defmac
5438
5439 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5440 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5441
5442 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5443 is used for aligning trampolines.
5444 @end defmac
5445
5446 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5447 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5448 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5449 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5450 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5451 when it is called.
5452
5453 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5454 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5455 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5456 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5457 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5458 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5459
5460 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5461 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5462 initializing the trampoline proper.
5463 @end deftypefn
5464
5465 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5466 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5467 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5468 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5469 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5470 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5471 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5472 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5473 @end deftypefn
5474
5475 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5476 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5477 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5478 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5479
5480 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5481 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5482 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5483 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5484 latter makes initialization faster.
5485
5486 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5487 the following macro.
5488
5489 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5490 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5491 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5492 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5493 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5494 @end defmac
5495
5496 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5497 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5498 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5499 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5500 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5501
5502 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5503 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5504 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5505 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5506 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5507
5508 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5509 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5510 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5511 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5512 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5513 special assembler code.
5514 @end defmac
5515
5516 @node Library Calls
5517 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5518 @cindex library subroutine names
5519 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5520
5521 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5522 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5523
5524 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5525 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5526 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5527 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5528 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5529 @end defmac
5530
5531 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5532 @findex init_one_libfunc
5533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5534 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5535 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5536 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5537 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5538 library routines.
5539
5540 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5541 @end deftypefn
5542
5543 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5544 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5545 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5546 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5547 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5548 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5549 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5550 @end deftypevr
5551
5552 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5553 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5554 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5555 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5556 return a tristate.
5557
5558 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5559 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5560 don't need to define this macro.
5561 @end defmac
5562
5563 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5564 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5565 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5566 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5567 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5568 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5569 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5570 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5571 @end defmac
5572
5573 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5574 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5575 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5576 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5577 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5578 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5579 @end defmac
5580
5581 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5582 @findex matherr
5583 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5584 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5585 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5586 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5587 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5588 system.
5589
5590 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5591 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5592 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5593 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5594 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5595 @end defmac
5596
5597 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5598 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5599 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5600 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5601 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5602 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5603 @end defmac
5604
5605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class}, tree @var{type})
5606 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5607 @var{fn_class} is present in the target C library. If @var{type} is NULL,
5608 the caller asks for support for all standard (float, double, long double)
5609 types. If @var{type} is non-NULL, the caller asks for support for a
5610 specific type.
5611 @end deftypefn
5612
5613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FAST_FUNCTION (int @var{fcode})
5614 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5615 @code{(enum function_class)}@var{fcode} has a fast implementation.
5616 @end deftypefn
5617
5618 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5619 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5620 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5621 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5622 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5623 the NeXT runtime installed.
5624
5625 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5626 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5627 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5628
5629 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5630 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5631 @end defmac
5632
5633 @node Addressing Modes
5634 @section Addressing Modes
5635 @cindex addressing modes
5636
5637 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5638 This is about addressing modes.
5639
5640 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5641 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5642 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5643 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5644 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5645 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5646 @end defmac
5647
5648 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5649 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5650 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5651 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5652 the size of the memory operand.
5653 @end defmac
5654
5655 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5656 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5657 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5658 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5659 @end defmac
5660
5661 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5662 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5663 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5664 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5665 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5666 constant addresses are supported.
5667 @end defmac
5668
5669 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5670 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5671 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5672 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5673 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5674 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5675 @end defmac
5676
5677 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5678 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5679 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5680 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5681 accept.
5682 @end defmac
5683
5684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5685 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5686 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5687
5688 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5689 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5690 desired by the caller.
5691
5692 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5693 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5694 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5695 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5696 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5697 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5698 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5699 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5700
5701 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5702 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5703 register is required.
5704
5705 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5706 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5707 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5708 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5709 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5710
5711 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5712 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5713 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5714 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5715 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5716
5717 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5718 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5719 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5720 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5721 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5722 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5723 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5724 Format}.
5725
5726 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5727 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5728 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5729 has this syntax:
5730
5731 @example
5732 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5733 @end example
5734
5735 @noindent
5736 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5737 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5738
5739 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5740 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5741 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5742 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5743 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5744
5745 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5746 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5747 @end deftypefn
5748
5749 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5750 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5751 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5752 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5753 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5754 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5755 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5756 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5757 @code{'m'} constraint.
5758 @end defmac
5759
5760 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5761 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5762 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5763 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5764 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5765
5766 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5767 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5768
5769 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5770 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5771 @end defmac
5772
5773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5774 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5775 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5776 address.
5777
5778 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5779 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5780 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5781 @var{x}.
5782
5783 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5784 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5785 should return the new @var{x}.
5786
5787 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5788 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5789 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5790 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5791 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5792 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5793 strategy can generate better code.
5794 @end deftypefn
5795
5796 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5797 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5798 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5799 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5800 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5801 performance reasons.
5802
5803 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5804 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5805 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5806 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5807 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5808 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5809 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5810 be shared.
5811
5812 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5813 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5814 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5815 of reload internals.
5816
5817 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5818 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5819 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5820
5821 @findex push_reload
5822 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5823 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5824 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5825
5826 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5827 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5828 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5829 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5830 @code{push_reload}.
5831
5832 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5833 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5834 the address has become legitimate.
5835
5836 @findex copy_rtx
5837 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5838 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5839 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5840 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5841 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5842 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5843 @end defmac
5844
5845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5846 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5847 space @var{addrspace} can have
5848 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5849 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5850 but not others.
5851
5852 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5853 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5854 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5855 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5856
5857 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5858
5859 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5860 @end deftypefn
5861
5862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5863 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5864 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5865 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5866
5867 The default definition returns true.
5868 @end deftypefn
5869
5870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5871 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5872 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5873 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5874 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5875 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5876 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5877 into their original form.
5878 @end deftypefn
5879
5880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5881 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5882 debug sections.
5883 @end deftypefn
5884
5885 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5886 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5887 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5888 of @var{x}.
5889
5890 The default version of this hook returns false.
5891
5892 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5893 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5894 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5895 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5896 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5897 @end deftypefn
5898
5899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5900 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5901 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5902 of @var{x}.
5903
5904 The default version returns false for all constants.
5905 @end deftypefn
5906
5907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5908 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5909 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5910
5911 The default version returns true for all decls.
5912 @end deftypefn
5913
5914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5915 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5916 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5917 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5918 @end deftypefn
5919
5920 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5921 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5922 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5923 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5924 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5925
5926 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5927 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5928 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5929 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5930 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5931 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5932 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5933 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5934 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5935 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5936 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5937
5938 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5939 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5940 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5941 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5942 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5943 described above.
5944 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5945 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5946 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5947 @end deftypefn
5948
5949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5950 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5951 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5952 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5953 @end deftypefn
5954
5955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_uint64 TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
5956 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to
5957 vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code. This might be less than
5958 or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by
5959 @code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}. It can be equal to the alignment of
5960 a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize
5961 for alignment.
5962
5963 The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is
5964 correct for most targets.
5965 @end deftypefn
5966
5967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5968 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
5969 @end deftypefn
5970
5971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{output}, rtx @var{in0}, rtx @var{in1}, const vec_perm_indices @var{&sel})
5972 This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two
5973 vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and
5974 also to emit such a permutation. In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1}
5975 and @var{out} are all null. In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are
5976 the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are
5977 registers of mode @var{mode}. @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if
5978 @var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two.
5979
5980 Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it
5981 if rtxes are provided.
5982
5983 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5984 If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will
5985 try the equivalent byte operation. If that also fails, it will try forcing
5986 the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}}
5987 instruction pattern. There is no need for the hook to handle these two
5988 implementation approaches itself.
5989 @end deftypefn
5990
5991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5992 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5993 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5994 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5995 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5996 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5997 @end deftypefn
5998
5999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
6000 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
6001 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
6002 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
6003 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
6004 @end deftypefn
6005
6006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
6007 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
6008 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
6009 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
6010 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
6011 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
6012 @end deftypefn
6013
6014 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode})
6015 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
6016 mode @var{mode}. The default is
6017 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
6018 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
6019 @end deftypefn
6020
6021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_SPLIT_REDUCTION (machine_mode)
6022 This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction
6023 step on @var{mode} to. The reduction is then carried out reducing upper
6024 against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is
6025 reached. The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting.
6026 @end deftypefn
6027
6028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_MODES (vector_modes *@var{modes}, bool @var{all})
6029 If using the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}
6030 is not the only approach worth considering, this hook should add one mode to
6031 @var{modes} for each useful alternative approach. These modes are then
6032 passed to @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_RELATED_MODE} to obtain the vector mode
6033 for a given element mode.
6034
6035 The modes returned in @var{modes} should use the smallest element mode
6036 possible for the vectorization approach that they represent, preferring
6037 integer modes over floating-poing modes in the event of a tie. The first
6038 mode should be the @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} for its
6039 element mode.
6040
6041 If @var{all} is true, add suitable vector modes even when they are generally
6042 not expected to be worthwhile.
6043
6044 The hook returns a bitmask of flags that control how the modes in
6045 @var{modes} are used. The flags are:
6046 @table @code
6047 @item VECT_COMPARE_COSTS
6048 Tells the loop vectorizer to try all the provided modes and pick the one
6049 with the lowest cost. By default the vectorizer will choose the first
6050 mode that works.
6051 @end table
6052
6053 The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by
6054 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant
6055 for autovectorization. The default implementation adds no modes and
6056 returns 0.
6057 @end deftypefn
6058
6059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_RELATED_MODE (machine_mode @var{vector_mode}, scalar_mode @var{element_mode}, poly_uint64 @var{nunits})
6060 If a piece of code is using vector mode @var{vector_mode} and also wants
6061 to operate on elements of mode @var{element_mode}, return the vector mode
6062 it should use for those elements. If @var{nunits} is nonzero, ensure that
6063 the mode has exactly @var{nunits} elements, otherwise pick whichever vector
6064 size pairs the most naturally with @var{vector_mode}. Return an empty
6065 @code{opt_machine_mode} if there is no supported vector mode with the
6066 required properties.
6067
6068 There is no prescribed way of handling the case in which @var{nunits}
6069 is zero. One common choice is to pick a vector mode with the same size
6070 as @var{vector_mode}; this is the natural choice if the target has a
6071 fixed vector size. Another option is to choose a vector mode with the
6072 same number of elements as @var{vector_mode}; this is the natural choice
6073 if the target has a fixed number of elements. Alternatively, the hook
6074 might choose a middle ground, such as trying to keep the number of
6075 elements as similar as possible while applying maximum and minimum
6076 vector sizes.
6077
6078 The default implementation uses @code{mode_for_vector} to find the
6079 requested mode, returning a mode with the same size as @var{vector_mode}
6080 when @var{nunits} is zero. This is the correct behavior for most targets.
6081 @end deftypefn
6082
6083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
6084 Return the mode to use for a vector mask that holds one boolean
6085 result for each element of vector mode @var{mode}. The returned mask mode
6086 can be a vector of integers (class @code{MODE_VECTOR_INT}), a vector of
6087 booleans (class @code{MODE_VECTOR_BOOL}) or a scalar integer (class
6088 @code{MODE_INT}). Return an empty @code{opt_machine_mode} if no such
6089 mask mode exists.
6090
6091 The default implementation returns a @code{MODE_VECTOR_INT} with the
6092 same size and number of elements as @var{mode}, if such a mode exists.
6093 @end deftypefn
6094
6095 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_EMPTY_MASK_IS_EXPENSIVE (unsigned @var{ifn})
6096 This hook returns true if masked internal function @var{ifn} (really of
6097 type @code{internal_fn}) should be considered expensive when the mask is
6098 all zeros. GCC can then try to branch around the instruction instead.
6099 @end deftypefn
6100
6101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (class loop *@var{loop_info})
6102 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
6103 @end deftypefn
6104
6105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (class vec_info *@var{}, void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, class _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
6106 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
6107 @end deftypefn
6108
6109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
6110 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
6111 @end deftypefn
6112
6113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
6114 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
6115 @end deftypefn
6116
6117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6118 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
6119 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6120 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6121 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
6122 loads.
6123 @end deftypefn
6124
6125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6126 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
6127 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6128 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6129 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
6130 stores.
6131 @end deftypefn
6132
6133 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
6134 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
6135 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
6136 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
6137 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
6138 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
6139 @end deftypefn
6140
6141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6142 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
6143 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
6144 @end deftypefn
6145
6146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6147 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
6148 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
6149 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
6150 to use it.
6151 @end deftypefn
6152
6153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
6154 Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
6155 @end deftypefn
6156
6157 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_OMP_DEVICE_KIND_ARCH_ISA (enum omp_device_kind_arch_isa @var{trait}, const char *@var{name})
6158 Return 1 if @var{trait} @var{name} is present in the OpenMP context's
6159 device trait set, return 0 if not present in any OpenMP context in the
6160 whole translation unit, or -1 if not present in the current OpenMP context
6161 but might be present in another OpenMP context in the same TU.
6162 @end deftypefn
6163
6164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level}, unsigned @var{used})
6165 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
6166 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
6167 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
6168 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine it is the
6169 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
6170 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
6171 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
6172 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
6173 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
6174 provide dimensions larger than 1.
6175 @end deftypefn
6176
6177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
6178 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
6179 or zero if unbounded.
6180 @end deftypefn
6181
6182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
6183 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
6184 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
6185 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
6186 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
6187 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
6188 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
6189 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
6190 @end deftypefn
6191
6192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
6193 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
6194 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
6195 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
6196 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
6197 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
6198 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
6199 @end deftypefn
6200
6201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PREFERRED_ELSE_VALUE (unsigned @var{ifn}, tree @var{type}, unsigned @var{nops}, tree *@var{ops})
6202 This hook returns the target's preferred final argument for a call
6203 to conditional internal function @var{ifn} (really of type
6204 @code{internal_fn}). @var{type} specifies the return type of the
6205 function and @var{ops} are the operands to the conditional operation,
6206 of which there are @var{nops}.
6207
6208 For example, if @var{ifn} is @code{IFN_COND_ADD}, the hook returns
6209 a value of type @var{type} that should be used when @samp{@var{ops}[0]}
6210 and @samp{@var{ops}[1]} are conditionally added together.
6211
6212 This hook is only relevant if the target supports conditional patterns
6213 like @code{cond_add@var{m}}. The default implementation returns a zero
6214 constant of type @var{type}.
6215 @end deftypefn
6216
6217 @node Anchored Addresses
6218 @section Anchored Addresses
6219 @cindex anchored addresses
6220 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
6221
6222 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
6223 For example, if we have:
6224
6225 @smallexample
6226 static int a, b, c;
6227 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
6228 @end smallexample
6229
6230 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
6231 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
6232 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
6233 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
6234 be something like:
6235
6236 @smallexample
6237 int foo (void)
6238 @{
6239 register int *xr = &x;
6240 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
6241 @}
6242 @end smallexample
6243
6244 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
6245 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
6246
6247 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
6248 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
6249 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
6250 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
6251
6252 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6253 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
6254 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
6255 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
6256 for every mode. The default value is 0.
6257 @end deftypevr
6258
6259 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6260 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
6261 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
6262 value is 0.
6263 @end deftypevr
6264
6265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
6266 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
6267 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
6268 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
6269 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
6270
6271 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
6272 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
6273 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
6274 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
6275 @end deftypefn
6276
6277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
6278 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
6279 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
6280 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
6281
6282 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
6283 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
6284 or target-specific sections.
6285 @end deftypefn
6286
6287 @node Condition Code
6288 @section Condition Code Status
6289 @cindex condition code status
6290
6291 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
6292 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
6293
6294 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
6295 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
6296 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
6297 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
6298 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
6299 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
6300 most RISC machines.
6301
6302 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
6303 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
6304 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
6305 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6306 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
6307 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6308
6309 These restrictions can prevent important
6310 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6311 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6312 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
6313 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6314 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6315
6316 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6317 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6318 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6319 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6320 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6321 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6322 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6323
6324 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6325 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6326 interested in most macros in this section.
6327
6328 @menu
6329 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6330 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6331 @end menu
6332
6333 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6334 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6335 @findex cc0
6336
6337 @findex cc_status
6338 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6339 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6340 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6341 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6342 currently based, and several standard flags.
6343
6344 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6345 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6346 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6347
6348 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6349 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6350 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6351
6352 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6353 @end defmac
6354
6355 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6356 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6357 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6358 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6359 define this macro to initialize it.
6360
6361 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6362 @end defmac
6363
6364 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6365 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6366 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6367 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6368 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6369 set @code{(cc0)}.
6370
6371 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6372
6373 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6374 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6375 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6376 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6377 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6378 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6379 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6380 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6381 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6382 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6383 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6384 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6385 condition code value.
6386
6387 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6388 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6389 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6390 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6391 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6392 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6393 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6394
6395 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6396 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6397 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6398 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6399 @end defmac
6400
6401 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6402 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6403 @findex CCmode
6404 @findex MODE_CC
6405
6406 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6407 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6408 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6409 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6410 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6411 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6412 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6413 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6414 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6415 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g.@: a signed or an
6416 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6417
6418 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6419 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6420 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6421 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6422 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6423 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6424 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6425
6426 @smallexample
6427 (define_insn ""
6428 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6429 (compare:CCNZ
6430 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6431 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6432 (const_int 0)))]
6433 ""
6434 "@dots{}")
6435 @end smallexample
6436
6437 @noindent
6438 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6439 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6440
6441 @smallexample
6442 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6443 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6444 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6445 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6446 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6447 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6448 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6449 @end smallexample
6450
6451 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6452 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6453 this section.
6454
6455 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6456 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6457 @end defmac
6458
6459 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6460 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6461 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6462 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6463 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6464
6465 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6466 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6467 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6468 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6469 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6470 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6471 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6472
6473 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6474 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6475 @file{md} file.
6476
6477 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6478 comparison code or operands.
6479 @end deftypefn
6480
6481 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6482 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6483 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6484 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6485 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6486
6487 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6488 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6489 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6490 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6491
6492 @smallexample
6493 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6494 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6495 @end smallexample
6496 @end defmac
6497
6498 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6499 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6500 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6501 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6502 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6503 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6504 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6505 like:
6506
6507 @smallexample
6508 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6509 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6510 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6511 @end smallexample
6512 @end defmac
6513
6514 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6515 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6516 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6517 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6518 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6519 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6520 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6521 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6522 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6523 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6524 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6525
6526 The default version of this hook returns false.
6527 @end deftypefn
6528
6529 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6530 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6531 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6532 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6533 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6534 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6535 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6536
6537 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6538 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6539 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6540 @end deftypefn
6541
6542 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6543 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the
6544 post-reload comparison elimination pass, or the delay slot filler pass,
6545 then this value should be set appropriately.
6546 @end deftypevr
6547
6548 @node Costs
6549 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6550 @cindex costs of instructions
6551 @cindex relative costs
6552 @cindex speed of instructions
6553
6554 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6555 on the target machine.
6556
6557 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6558 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6559 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6560 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6561 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6562 that.
6563
6564 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6565 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6566 registers if they are not general registers.
6567
6568 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6569 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6570 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6571 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6572 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6573 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6574
6575 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6576 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6577 @end defmac
6578
6579 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6580 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6581 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6582 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6583 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6584 that.
6585
6586 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6587 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6588 registers if they are not general registers.
6589
6590 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6591 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6592 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6593 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6594 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6595 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6596
6597 The default version of this function returns 2.
6598 @end deftypefn
6599
6600 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6601 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6602 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6603 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6604 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6605 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6606 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6607
6608 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6609 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6610 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6611 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6612 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6613 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6614
6615 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6616 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6617 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6618 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6619 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6620 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6621 are the same as to this macro.
6622
6623 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6624 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6625 @end defmac
6626
6627 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6628 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6629 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6630 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6631 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6632 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6633 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6634
6635 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6636 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6637 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6638 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6639 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6640 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6641
6642 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6643 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6644 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6645 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6646 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6647 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6648 are the same as to this target hook.
6649 @end deftypefn
6650
6651 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6652 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6653 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6654 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6655 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6656 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6657 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6658 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6659 @end defmac
6660
6661 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6662 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6663 ordinarily expect.
6664
6665 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6666 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6667 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6668 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6669 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6670 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6671
6672 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6673 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6674 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6675 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6676 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6677 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6678 @end defmac
6679
6680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned int @var{align})
6681 This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the
6682 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6683 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler.
6684 This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e.@: when
6685 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6686
6687 When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if
6688 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block
6689 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6690 Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only
6691 add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6692
6693 The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true.
6694 The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}.
6695 @end deftypefn
6696
6697 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6698 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6699 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6700 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6701 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6702
6703 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6704 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6705 the number of such sequences.
6706
6707 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6708 optimized for speed rather than size.
6709
6710 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6711 @end defmac
6712
6713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6714 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6715 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6716 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6717 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6718 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6719 @code{cpymem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6720 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6721
6722 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6723 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6724 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6725 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6726 units.
6727
6728 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6729 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6730 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6731 under consideration.
6732
6733 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6734 optimized for speed rather than size.
6735
6736 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6737 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6738 @code{cpymem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{cpymem} or
6739 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6740 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6741 the body of the memory operation.
6742
6743 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6744 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6745 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6746 @end deftypefn
6747
6748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6749 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6750 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6751 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6752 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6753 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6754 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6755 negative number from this hook.
6756 @end deftypefn
6757
6758 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6759 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6760 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6761 @end defmac
6762
6763 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6764 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6765 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6766 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6767 @end defmac
6768
6769 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6770 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6771 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6772 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6773 @end defmac
6774
6775 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6776 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6777 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6778 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6779 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6780
6781 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6782 optimized for speed rather than size.
6783
6784 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6785 @end defmac
6786
6787 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6788 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6789 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6790 a block set insn or a library call.
6791 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6792 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6793
6794 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6795 optimized for speed rather than size.
6796
6797 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6798 @end defmac
6799
6800 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6801 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6802 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6803 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6804 @end defmac
6805
6806 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6807 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6808 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6809 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6810 @end defmac
6811
6812 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6813 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6814 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6815 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6816 @end defmac
6817
6818 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6819 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6820 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6821 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6822 @end defmac
6823
6824 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6825 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6826 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6827 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6828 @end defmac
6829
6830 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6831 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6832 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6833 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6834 @end defmac
6835
6836 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6837 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6838 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6839 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6840 @end defmac
6841
6842 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6843 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6844 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6845 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6846 @end defmac
6847
6848 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6849 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6850 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6851 @end defmac
6852
6853 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6854 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6855 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6856 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6857 @end defmac
6858
6859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6860 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6861 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6862 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6863 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6864 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6865
6866 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6867 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6868 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6869
6870 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6871 @end deftypefn
6872
6873 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6874 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6875
6876 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6877 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6878 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6879 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6880 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6881 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6882 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6883
6884 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6885 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6886
6887 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6888 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6889 instructions.
6890
6891 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6892 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6893 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6894 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6895 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6896
6897 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6898 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6899 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6900
6901 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6902 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6903 @end deftypefn
6904
6905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6906 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6907 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6908 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6909
6910 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6911 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6912 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6913 all addresses will have equal costs.
6914
6915 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6916 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6917 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6918
6919 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6920 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6921 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6922 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6923 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6924 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6925 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6926 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6927
6928 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6929
6930 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6931 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6932 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6933 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6934 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6935 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6936 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6937 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6938 @end deftypefn
6939
6940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_INSN_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, bool @var{speed})
6941 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions.
6942
6943 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6944 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6945 instructions.
6946
6947 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6948 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6949 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6950 @end deftypefn
6951
6952 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6953 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6954 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6955 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6956 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6957 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6958 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6959 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6960 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6961 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6962
6963 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6964 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6965 were true.
6966
6967 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6968 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6969 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6970 @end deftypefn
6971
6972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6973 This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6974 candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6975 @code{if_info}.
6976 @end deftypefn
6977
6978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NEW_ADDRESS_PROFITABLE_P (rtx @var{memref}, rtx_insn * @var{insn}, rtx @var{new_addr})
6979 Return @code{true} if it is profitable to replace the address in
6980 @var{memref} with @var{new_addr}. This allows targets to prevent the
6981 scheduler from undoing address optimizations. The instruction containing the
6982 memref is @var{insn}. The default implementation returns @code{true}.
6983 @end deftypefn
6984
6985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6986 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6987 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6988 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6989 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6990 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6991 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6992 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6993 @end deftypefn
6994
6995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ESTIMATED_POLY_VALUE (poly_int64 @var{val})
6996 Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in
6997 things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies. The default
6998 implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}.
6999 @end deftypefn
7000
7001 @node Scheduling
7002 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
7003
7004 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
7005 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
7006 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
7007 them: try the first ones in this list first.
7008
7009 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
7010 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
7011 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
7012 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
7013 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
7014 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
7015 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
7016 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
7017 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
7018 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
7019 @end deftypefn
7020
7021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
7022 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
7023 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
7024 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
7025 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
7026 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
7027 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
7028 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
7029 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
7030 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7031 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
7032 was scheduled.
7033 @end deftypefn
7034
7035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
7036 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
7037 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
7038 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
7039 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
7040 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
7041 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
7042 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
7043 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
7044 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
7045 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
7046 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
7047 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
7048 @end deftypefn
7049
7050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
7051 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
7052 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
7053 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
7054 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
7055 scheduling priorities of insns.
7056 @end deftypefn
7057
7058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
7059 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
7060 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
7061 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
7062 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
7063 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7064 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
7065 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
7066 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
7067 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
7068 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
7069 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
7070 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
7071 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
7072 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
7073 @end deftypefn
7074
7075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
7076 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
7077 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
7078 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
7079 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
7080 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
7081 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
7082 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
7083 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
7084 @end deftypefn
7085
7086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
7087 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
7088 @end deftypefn
7089
7090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
7091 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
7092 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
7093 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
7094 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
7095 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
7096 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
7097 @end deftypefn
7098
7099 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
7100 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
7101 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
7102 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
7103 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
7104 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
7105 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
7106 calculated.
7107 @end deftypefn
7108
7109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
7110 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
7111 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
7112 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
7113 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7114 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
7115 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
7116 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
7117 @end deftypefn
7118
7119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7120 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
7121 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
7122 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
7123 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
7124 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7125 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7126 @end deftypefn
7127
7128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
7129 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
7130 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7131 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7132 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
7133 @end deftypefn
7134
7135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7136 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
7137 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7138 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7139 @end deftypefn
7140
7141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7142 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
7143 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
7144 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
7145 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
7146 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
7147 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
7148 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
7149 @end deftypefn
7150
7151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7152 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7153 @end deftypefn
7154
7155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7156 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7157 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
7158 simulated processor cycle finishes.
7159 @end deftypefn
7160
7161 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7162 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
7163 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7164 @end deftypefn
7165
7166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7167 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
7168 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7169 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7170 state on a single insn is not enough.
7171 @end deftypefn
7172
7173 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7174 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
7175 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7176 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7177 state on a single insn is not enough.
7178 @end deftypefn
7179
7180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
7181 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
7182 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
7183 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
7184 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
7185 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
7186 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
7187 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
7188 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
7189 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
7190 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
7191
7192 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
7193 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
7194 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
7195 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
7196 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
7197 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
7198 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
7199 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
7200 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
7201
7202 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
7203 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
7204 schedules to choose the best one.
7205
7206 The default is no multipass scheduling.
7207 @end deftypefn
7208
7209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
7210
7211 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
7212 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
7213 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
7214 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
7215 the current round of multipass scheduling.
7216 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
7217 number of cycles.
7218 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
7219 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
7220 to allow backends make correct judgements.
7221
7222 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
7223 @end deftypefn
7224
7225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
7226 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
7227 scheduling.
7228 @end deftypefn
7229
7230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
7231 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
7232 @end deftypefn
7233
7234 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
7235 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
7236 an instruction.
7237 @end deftypefn
7238
7239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
7240 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
7241 round of multipass scheduling.
7242 @end deftypefn
7243
7244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
7245 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7246 @end deftypefn
7247
7248 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
7249 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7250 @end deftypefn
7251
7252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
7253 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
7254 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
7255 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
7256 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
7257 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
7258 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
7259 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
7260 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
7261 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
7262 and the current processor cycle.
7263 @end deftypefn
7264
7265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
7266 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
7267 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
7268 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
7269 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
7270 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
7271 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
7272 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
7273 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
7274 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
7275 and @code{false} otherwise.
7276
7277 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
7278 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
7279 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
7280 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
7281 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
7282 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
7283 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
7284 @end deftypefn
7285
7286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
7287 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
7288 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
7289 per instruction data structures.
7290 @end deftypefn
7291
7292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
7293 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
7294 @end deftypefn
7295
7296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
7297 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
7298 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
7299 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
7300 @end deftypefn
7301
7302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7303 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
7304 @end deftypefn
7305
7306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7307 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7308 @end deftypefn
7309
7310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7311 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7312 @end deftypefn
7313
7314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
7315 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
7316 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
7317 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
7318 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
7319 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
7320 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
7321 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
7322 the generated speculative pattern.
7323 @end deftypefn
7324
7325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
7326 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
7327 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
7328 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
7329 @end deftypefn
7330
7331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
7332 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
7333 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7334 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7335 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7336 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7337 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7338 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
7339 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7340 @end deftypefn
7341
7342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
7343 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
7344 enabled/used.
7345 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7346 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7347 @end deftypefn
7348
7349 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7350 Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7351 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such
7352 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7353 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7354 should not be speculated.
7355 @end deftypefn
7356
7357 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7358 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7359 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7360 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7361 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7362 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7363 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7364 @end deftypefn
7365
7366 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7367 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7368 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7369 @end deftypefn
7370
7371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7372 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7373 in its second parameter.
7374 @end deftypefn
7375
7376 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7377 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7378 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7379 also the latencies of operations.
7380 @end deftypevr
7381
7382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7383 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7384 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7385 @end deftypefn
7386
7387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7388 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7389 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7390 are returned via pointer parameters.
7391
7392 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7393 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7394 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7395 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7396 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7397 should be calculated and returned.
7398
7399 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7400 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7401 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7402 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7403 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7404 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7405 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7406 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7407 instructions.
7408
7409 Given below example:
7410
7411 @smallexample
7412 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7413 add r4, r4, r10
7414 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7415 sub r5, r5, r15
7416 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7417 add r4, r4, r11
7418 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7419 sub r5, r5, r16
7420 @end smallexample
7421
7422 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7423 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7424 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7425 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7426 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7427
7428 @smallexample
7429 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7430 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7431 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7432 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7433 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7434 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7435 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7436 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7437 @end smallexample
7438
7439 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7440 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7441 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7442
7443 @smallexample
7444 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7445 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7446 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7447 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7448 add r4, r4, r10
7449 sub r5, r5, r15
7450 add r4, r4, r11
7451 sub r5, r5, r16
7452 @end smallexample
7453
7454 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7455
7456 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7457 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7458
7459 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7460 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7461 @end deftypefn
7462
7463 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7464 Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7465 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7466 @end deftypefn
7467
7468 @node Sections
7469 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7470 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7471 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7472
7473 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7474 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7475 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7476 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7477 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7478 of sections.
7479
7480 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7481 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7482 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7483 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7484 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7485 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7486 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7487
7488 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7489 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7490 to be string literals.
7491
7492 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7493 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7494 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7495 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7496
7497 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7498 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7499 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7500 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7501 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7502 reuse @code{text_section}.
7503
7504 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7505 if the target does not provide them.
7506
7507 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7508 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7509 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7510 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7511 @end defmac
7512
7513 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7514 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7515 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7516 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7517 @end defmac
7518
7519 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7520 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7521 executed functions in the program.
7522 @end defmac
7523
7524 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7525 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7526 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7527 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7528 @end defmac
7529
7530 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7531 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7532 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7533 initialized, writable small data.
7534 @end defmac
7535
7536 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7537 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7538 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7539 data.
7540 @end defmac
7541
7542 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7543 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7544 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7545 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7546 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7547 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7548 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7549 used.
7550 @end defmac
7551
7552 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7553 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7554 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7555 uninitialized, writable small data.
7556 @end defmac
7557
7558 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7559 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7560 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7561 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7562 @end defmac
7563
7564 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7565 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7566 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7567 default is @code{'T'}.
7568 @end defmac
7569
7570 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7571 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7572 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7573 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7574 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7575 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7576 @end defmac
7577
7578 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7579 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7580 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7581 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7582 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7583 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7584 @end defmac
7585
7586 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7587 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7588 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7589 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7590 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7591 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7592 @end defmac
7593
7594 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7595 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7596 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7597 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7598 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7599 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7600 @end defmac
7601
7602 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7603 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7604 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7605 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7606 @end defmac
7607
7608 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7609 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7610 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7611 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7612 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7613 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7614 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7615 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7616 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7617 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7618 @end defmac
7619
7620 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7621 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7622 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7623 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7624 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7625 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7626 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7627 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7628 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7629 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7630 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7631 @end defmac
7632
7633 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7634 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7635 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7636 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7637 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7638 @end defmac
7639
7640 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7641 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7642 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7643 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7644 readonly data section is used.
7645
7646 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7647 @end defmac
7648
7649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7650 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7651 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7652 of its own that you need to create.
7653
7654 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7655 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7656 described below.
7657 @end deftypefn
7658
7659 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7660 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7661 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7662 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7663 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7664
7665 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7666 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7667 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7668 in read-only sections even in executables.
7669 @end deftypefn
7670
7671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_GENERATE_PIC_ADDR_DIFF_VEC (void)
7672 Return true to generate ADDR_DIF_VEC table
7673 or false to generate ADDR_VEC table for jumps in case of -fPIC.
7674
7675 The default version of this function returns true if flag_pic
7676 equals true and false otherwise
7677 @end deftypefn
7678
7679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7680 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7681 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7682 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7683 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7684 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7685 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7686
7687 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7688 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7689
7690 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7691 @end deftypefn
7692
7693 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7694 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7695 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7696
7697 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7698 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7699 it is unlikely to be called.
7700 @end defmac
7701
7702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7703 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7704 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7705 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7706 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7707
7708 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7709 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7710 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7711 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7712 @end deftypefn
7713
7714 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7715 Return the readonly data section associated with
7716 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7717 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7718 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7719 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7720 otherwise.
7721 @end deftypefn
7722
7723 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7724 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7725 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7726 the string if a different section name should be used.
7727 @end deftypevr
7728
7729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7730 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7731 @end deftypefn
7732
7733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7734 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7735 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7736 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7737 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7738 in bits.
7739
7740 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7741 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7742 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7743 @end deftypefn
7744
7745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7746 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7747 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7748 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7749 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7750 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7751 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7752 returns the @var{id} provided.
7753 @end deftypefn
7754
7755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7756 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7757 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7758 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7759
7760 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7761 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7762 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7763 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7764 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7765
7766 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7767 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7768 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7769 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7770 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7771 leave it alone.)
7772
7773 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7774 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7775 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7776 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7777 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7778 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7779
7780 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7781 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7782 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7783 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7784 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7785 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7786
7787 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7788 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7789 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7790 before overriding it.
7791 @end deftypefn
7792
7793 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7794 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7795 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7796 may have added.
7797 @end deftypefn
7798
7799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7800 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7801 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7802 @end deftypefn
7803
7804 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7805 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7806 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7807 @end deftypevr
7808
7809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7810 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7811
7812 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7813 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7814 @end deftypefn
7815
7816 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7817 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7818 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7819 or executable image).
7820
7821 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7822 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7823 currently supported object file formats.
7824 @end deftypefn
7825
7826 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7827 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7828 The default value is false.
7829 @end deftypevr
7830
7831
7832 @node PIC
7833 @section Position Independent Code
7834 @cindex position independent code
7835 @cindex PIC
7836
7837 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7838 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7839 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7840 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7841 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7842 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7843 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7844 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7845 relative addresses.
7846 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7847 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7848
7849 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7850 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7851 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7852 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7853 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7854 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7855 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7856 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7857 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7858 @end defmac
7859
7860 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7861 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7862 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7863 the default is zero. Do not define
7864 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7865 @end defmac
7866
7867 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7868 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7869 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7870 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7871 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7872 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7873 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7874 position independent code.
7875 @end defmac
7876
7877 @node Assembler Format
7878 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7879
7880 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7881 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7882 instructions do.
7883
7884 @menu
7885 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7886 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7887 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7888 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7889 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7890 and termination routines.
7891 * Macros for Initialization::
7892 Specific macros that control the handling of
7893 initialization and termination routines.
7894 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7895 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7896 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7897 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7898 @end menu
7899
7900 @node File Framework
7901 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7902 @cindex assembler format
7903 @cindex output of assembler code
7904
7905 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7906 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7907
7908 @findex default_file_start
7909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7910 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7911 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7912 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7913 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7914 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7915 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7916 @end deftypefn
7917
7918 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7919 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7920 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7921 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7922 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7923 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7924 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7925 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7926
7927 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7928 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7929 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7930 @end deftypevr
7931
7932 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7933 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7934 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7935 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7936 this to be done. The default is false.
7937 @end deftypevr
7938
7939 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7940 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7941 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7942 @end deftypefn
7943
7944 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7945 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7946 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7947 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7948 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7949 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7950 this function.
7951 @end deftypefun
7952
7953 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7954 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7955 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7956 nothing.
7957 @end deftypefn
7958
7959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7960 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7961 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7962 nothing.
7963 @end deftypefn
7964
7965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7966 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7967 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7968 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7969 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7970 nothing.
7971 @end deftypefn
7972
7973 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7974 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7975 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7976 the end of the line.
7977 @end defmac
7978
7979 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7980 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7981 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7982 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7983 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7984 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7985 @end defmac
7986
7987 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7988 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7989 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7990 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7991 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7992 @end defmac
7993
7994 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7995 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7996 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7997 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7998
7999 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8000 for the file format in use is appropriate.
8001 @end defmac
8002
8003 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
8004 Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
8005
8006 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
8007 @end deftypefn
8008
8009 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
8010 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
8011 @end deftypefn
8012
8013 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
8014 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
8015 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
8016 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
8017 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
8018 of the filename using this macro.
8019 @end defmac
8020
8021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
8022 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
8023 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
8024 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
8025 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
8026 this section is associated.
8027 @end deftypefn
8028
8029 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
8030 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
8031 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
8032 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
8033 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
8034 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
8035 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
8036 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
8037 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
8038 is emitted.
8039 @end deftypefn
8040
8041 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
8042 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
8043 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
8044 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
8045 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
8046 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
8047 (from static destructors).
8048 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
8049 @end deftypefn
8050
8051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
8052 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
8053 @end deftypefn
8054
8055 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
8056 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
8057 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
8058 @end deftypevr
8059
8060 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
8061 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
8062 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
8063 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
8064 This is true on most ELF targets.
8065 @end deftypevr
8066
8067 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
8068 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
8069 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
8070 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
8071 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
8072
8073 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
8074 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
8075 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
8076 set via @code{__attribute__}.
8077 @end deftypefn
8078
8079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
8080 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
8081 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
8082 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
8083 It can take the following values:
8084
8085 @table @gcctabopt
8086 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
8087 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
8088
8089 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
8090 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
8091 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
8092 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
8093 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
8094 various different individual optimization passes.
8095
8096 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
8097 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
8098 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
8099 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
8100 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
8101 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
8102 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
8103 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
8104 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
8105 switches.
8106
8107 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
8108 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8109
8110 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
8111 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8112 @end table
8113
8114 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
8115 supported in the future.
8116
8117 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
8118 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
8119 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
8120 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
8121 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
8122 hook.
8123 @end deftypefn
8124
8125 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
8126 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
8127 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
8128 hook.
8129 @end deftypevr
8130
8131 @need 2000
8132 @node Data Output
8133 @subsection Output of Data
8134
8135
8136 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
8137 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
8138 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PSI_OP
8139 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
8140 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PDI_OP
8141 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
8142 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PTI_OP
8143 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
8144 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
8145 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PSI_OP
8146 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
8147 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PDI_OP
8148 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
8149 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PTI_OP
8150 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
8151 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
8152 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
8153 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
8154 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
8155 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
8156
8157 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
8158 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
8159 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
8160 @end deftypevr
8161
8162 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
8163 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
8164 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
8165 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
8166 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
8167 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
8168 split the object into smaller parts.
8169
8170 The default implementation of this hook will use the
8171 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
8172 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
8173 @end deftypefn
8174
8175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
8176 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
8177 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
8178 @end deftypefn
8179
8180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
8181 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
8182 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
8183 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
8184 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
8185
8186 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
8187 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
8188 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
8189 return @code{true}.
8190 @end deftypefn
8191
8192 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
8193 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8194 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
8195 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
8196 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
8197
8198 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
8199 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
8200 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
8201 @end defmac
8202
8203 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
8204 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
8205 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
8206 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
8207 @end defmac
8208
8209 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
8210 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
8211 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
8212 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
8213 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
8214 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
8215 pool before the function.
8216 @end defmac
8217
8218 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
8219 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
8220 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
8221 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
8222 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
8223 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
8224 immediately after this call.
8225
8226 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
8227 not be defined.
8228 @end defmac
8229
8230 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
8231 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
8232 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
8233 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
8234
8235 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
8236 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
8237 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
8238 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
8239 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
8240 alignment.
8241
8242 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
8243 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
8244 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
8245 Here is how to do this:
8246
8247 @smallexample
8248 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
8249 @end smallexample
8250
8251 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
8252 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
8253 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
8254
8255 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
8256 @end defmac
8257
8258 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
8259 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
8260 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
8261 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
8262 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
8263 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
8264
8265 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
8266 define this macro.
8267 @end defmac
8268
8269 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
8270 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
8271 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
8272 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
8273 a line separator uses multiple characters.
8274
8275 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
8276 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
8277 @end defmac
8278
8279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
8280 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
8281 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
8282 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
8283 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8284 @end deftypevr
8285
8286 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
8287 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
8288
8289 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8290 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8291 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8292 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8293 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8294 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8295 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
8296 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
8297 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
8298 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
8299 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
8300 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
8301 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
8302 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
8303 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
8304 on the host machine.
8305
8306 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
8307 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
8308 machine's memory.
8309 @end defmac
8310
8311 @node Uninitialized Data
8312 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
8313
8314 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
8315 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
8316
8317 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8318 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8319 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
8320 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8321 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
8322 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
8323 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
8324 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
8325 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
8326 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
8327 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
8328 an ordinary undefined external.
8329
8330 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8331 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8332 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8333
8334 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8335 common global variables are output.
8336 @end defmac
8337
8338 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8339 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
8340 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8341 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
8342 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8343 as the number of bits.
8344 @end defmac
8345
8346 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8347 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8348 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8349 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8350 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8351 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
8352 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8353 @end defmac
8354
8355 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8356 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8357 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
8358 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
8359 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
8360
8361 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8362 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
8363 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8364 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8365 the name, and a newline.
8366
8367 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
8368 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8369 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8370 You do not need to do both.
8371
8372 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8373 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8374 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8375 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8376 common in order to save space in the object file.
8377 @end defmac
8378
8379 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8380 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8381 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8382 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8383 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8384
8385 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8386 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8387 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8388
8389 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8390 static variables are output.
8391 @end defmac
8392
8393 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8394 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8395 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8396 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8397 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8398 as the number of bits.
8399 @end defmac
8400
8401 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8402 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL} except that @var{decl} of the
8403 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8404 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8405 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} and
8406 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8407 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8408 @end defmac
8409
8410 @node Label Output
8411 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8412
8413 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8414 This is about outputting labels.
8415
8416 @findex assemble_name
8417 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8418 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8419 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8420 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8421 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8422 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8423 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8424 @end defmac
8425
8426 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8427 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8428 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8429 a function.
8430 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8431 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8432 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8433 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8434
8435 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8436 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8437 @end defmac
8438
8439 @findex assemble_name_raw
8440 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8441 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8442 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8443 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8444 that it is more efficient.
8445 @end defmac
8446
8447 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8448 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8449 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8450 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8451 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8452
8453 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8454 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8455 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8456 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8457 define this macro.
8458 @end defmac
8459
8460 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8461 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8462 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8463 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8464 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8465 provided.
8466 @end defmac
8467
8468 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8469 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8470 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8471 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8472 address.
8473
8474 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8475 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8476 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8477 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8478 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8479 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8480 @end defmac
8481
8482 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8483 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8484 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8485 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8486 @samp{.} is used instead.
8487 @end defmac
8488
8489 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8490 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8491 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8492 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8493 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8494 @end defmac
8495
8496 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8497 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8498 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8499 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8500 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8501
8502 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8503 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8504 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8505 types at all, do not define this macro.
8506 @end defmac
8507
8508 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8509 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8510 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8511 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8512 the default is not to define this macro.
8513
8514 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8515 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8516 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8517 types at all, do not define this macro.
8518 @end defmac
8519
8520 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8521 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8522 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8523 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8524 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8525 you should not count on this.
8526
8527 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8528 definition of this macro is provided.
8529 @end defmac
8530
8531 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8532 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8533 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8534 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8535 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8536 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8537 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8538
8539 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8540 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8541
8542 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8543 of this macro.
8544 @end defmac
8545
8546 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8547 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8548 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8549 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8550 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8551 representing the function.
8552
8553 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8554
8555 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8556 of this macro.
8557 @end defmac
8558
8559 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8560 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8561 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8562 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8563 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8564 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8565 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8566
8567 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8568 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8569
8570 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8571 of this macro.
8572 @end defmac
8573
8574 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8575 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8576 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8577 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8578 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8579 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8580
8581 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8582
8583 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8584 of this macro.
8585 @end defmac
8586
8587 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8588 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8589 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8590 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8591 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8592 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8593
8594 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8595 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8596
8597 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8598 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8599 @end defmac
8600
8601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8602 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8603 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8604 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8605 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8606 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8607 will be an internal label.
8608
8609 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8610 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8611
8612 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8613 @end deftypefn
8614
8615 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8616 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8617 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8618 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8619
8620 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8621 nothing.
8622 @end defmac
8623
8624 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8625 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8626 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8627 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8628 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8629 something about the size of the object.
8630
8631 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8632 nothing.
8633
8634 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8635 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8636 @end defmac
8637
8638 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8639 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8640 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8641 that is, available for reference from other files.
8642
8643 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8644 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8645 @end deftypefn
8646
8647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8648 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8649 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8650 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8651
8652 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8653 @end deftypefn
8654
8655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8656 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8657 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8658 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8659 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8660 @end deftypefn
8661
8662 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8663 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8664 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8665 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8666 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8667 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8668 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8669 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8670
8671 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8672 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8673 macro.
8674 @end defmac
8675
8676 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8677 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8678 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8679 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8680 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8681 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8682 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8683 to make @var{name} weak.
8684 @end defmac
8685
8686 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8687 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8688 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8689 declaration of @code{name}.
8690 @end defmac
8691
8692 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8693 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8694 supports weak symbols.
8695
8696 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8697 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8698 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8699 @end defmac
8700
8701 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8702 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8703
8704 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8705 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8706 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8707 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8708 @end defmac
8709
8710 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8711 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8712 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8713 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8714 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8715 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8716 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8717 @end defmac
8718
8719 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8720 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8721 semantics.
8722
8723 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8724 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8725 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8726 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8727 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8728 be emitted as one-only.
8729 @end defmac
8730
8731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8732 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8733 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8734 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8735 @end deftypefn
8736
8737 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8738 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8739 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8740 The default is @code{0}.
8741
8742 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8743 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8744 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8745 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8746 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8747 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8748 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8749
8750 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8751 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8752 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8753 table of contents.
8754 @end defmac
8755
8756 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8757 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8758 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8759 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8760 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8761 declaration.
8762
8763 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8764 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8765 @end defmac
8766
8767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8768 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8769 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8770 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8771 @end deftypefn
8772
8773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8774 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8775 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8776 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8777 @end deftypefn
8778
8779 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8780 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8781 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8782 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8783 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8784 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8785 @end defmac
8786
8787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8788 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8789 @end deftypefn
8790
8791 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8792 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8793 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8794 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8795 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8796 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8797 @end defmac
8798
8799 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8800 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8801 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8802 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8803 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8804 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8805 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8806 being taken.
8807 @end defmac
8808
8809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8810 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8811 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8812
8813 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8814 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8815 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8816
8817 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8818 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8819 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8820 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8821 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8822
8823 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8824 @end deftypefn
8825
8826 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8827 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8828 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8829 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8830 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8831 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8832 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8833 bundles.
8834
8835 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8836 used.
8837 @end defmac
8838
8839 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8840 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8841 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8842
8843 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8844 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8845 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8846
8847 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8848 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8849 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8850 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8851 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8852 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8853 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8854 @end defmac
8855
8856 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8857 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8858 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8859 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8860 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8861
8862 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8863 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8864 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8865 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8866 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8867 internal static variables in different scopes.
8868
8869 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8870 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8871 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8872 between the name and the number will suffice.
8873
8874 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8875 which is correct for most systems.
8876 @end defmac
8877
8878 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8879 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8880 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8881
8882 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8883 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8884 correct for most systems.
8885 @end defmac
8886
8887 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8888 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8889 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8890 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8891 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8892 the tree nodes are available.
8893
8894 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8895 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8896 correct for most systems.
8897 @end defmac
8898
8899 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8900 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8901 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8902 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8903 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8904 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8905 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8906 @end defmac
8907
8908 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8909 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8910 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8911 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8912 an undefined weak symbol.
8913
8914 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8915 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8916 @end defmac
8917
8918 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8919 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8920 Objective-C methods.
8921
8922 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8923 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8924 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8925 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8926
8927 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8928 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8929 systems define other ways of computing names.
8930
8931 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8932 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8933 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8934 50 characters extra.
8935
8936 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8937 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8938 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8939 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8940
8941 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8942 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8943 @end defmac
8944
8945 @node Initialization
8946 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8947 @cindex initialization routines
8948 @cindex termination routines
8949 @cindex constructors, output of
8950 @cindex destructors, output of
8951
8952 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8953 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8954 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8955 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8956 @code{main} is called.
8957
8958 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8959 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8960 terminates.
8961
8962 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8963 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8964 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8965 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8966
8967 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8968 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8969 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8970
8971 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8972 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8973 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8974 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8975 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8976
8977 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8978 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8979 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8980 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8981 pointer containing zero.
8982
8983 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8984 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8985 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8986 list; destructors in forward order.
8987
8988 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8989 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8990 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8991 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8992 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8993 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8994 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8995 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8996
8997 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8998 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8999 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
9000 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
9001 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
9002
9003 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
9004 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
9005 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
9006 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
9007 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
9008
9009 @smallexample
9010 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
9011 @end smallexample
9012
9013 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
9014 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
9015 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
9016 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
9017 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
9018
9019 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
9020 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
9021 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
9022 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
9023 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
9024 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
9025
9026 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
9027 macro properly.
9028
9029 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
9030 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
9031 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
9032 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
9033 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
9034 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
9035
9036 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
9037 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
9038 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
9039 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
9040 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
9041 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
9042 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
9043 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
9044 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
9045 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
9046 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
9047 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
9048 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
9049 the initialization process.
9050
9051 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
9052 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
9053 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
9054 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
9055 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
9056 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
9057 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
9058 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
9059 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
9060 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
9061 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
9062
9063 @ifinfo
9064 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
9065 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
9066 @end ifinfo
9067
9068 @node Macros for Initialization
9069 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
9070
9071 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
9072 and termination functions:
9073
9074 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
9075 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
9076 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
9077 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
9078 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
9079 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
9080 run the initialization functions.
9081 @end defmac
9082
9083 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
9084 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
9085 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
9086 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
9087 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
9088 @end defmac
9089
9090 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
9091 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9092 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
9093 @end defmac
9094
9095 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
9096 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9097 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
9098 @end defmac
9099
9100 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9101 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9102 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
9103 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9104 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
9105 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
9106
9107 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
9108 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
9109 exception tables embedded in the code.
9110 @end defmac
9111
9112 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9113 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9114 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
9115 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9116 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
9117 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
9118 @end defmac
9119
9120 @defmac INVOKE__main
9121 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
9122 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
9123 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
9124 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
9125 @end defmac
9126
9127 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
9128 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
9129 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
9130 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
9131 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
9132 @end defmac
9133
9134 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
9135 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
9136 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
9137 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
9138 @end deftypevr
9139
9140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9141 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
9142 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
9143
9144 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
9145 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
9146 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
9147 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
9148
9149 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
9150 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
9151 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
9152 is not defined.
9153 @end deftypefn
9154
9155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9156 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
9157 functions rather than initialization functions.
9158 @end deftypefn
9159
9160 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
9161 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
9162
9163 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
9164 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
9165 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
9166
9167 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
9168 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
9169
9170 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
9171 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
9172 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
9173 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
9174
9175 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
9176 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
9177 @end defmac
9178
9179 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
9180 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
9181 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
9182 @command{nm}.
9183 @end defmac
9184
9185 @defmac NM_FLAGS
9186 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
9187 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
9188 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
9189 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
9190 produces.
9191 @end defmac
9192
9193 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
9194 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
9195 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
9196 termination functions in shared libraries:
9197
9198 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
9199 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
9200 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
9201 @end defmac
9202
9203 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
9204 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
9205 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
9206 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
9207 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
9208 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
9209 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
9210 @end defmac
9211
9212 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
9213 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
9214 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
9215 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
9216 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
9217 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
9218 @end defmac
9219
9220 @node Instruction Output
9221 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
9222
9223 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9224 This describes assembler instruction output.
9225
9226 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
9227 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
9228 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
9229 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
9230 @end defmac
9231
9232 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9233 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
9234 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
9235 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
9236 to registers using alternate names.
9237 @end defmac
9238
9239 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
9240 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
9241 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
9242 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
9243 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
9244 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
9245 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
9246 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
9247
9248 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
9249 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
9250 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
9251 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
9252 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
9253 @end defmac
9254
9255 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
9256 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
9257 requires different names for the machine instructions.
9258
9259 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
9260 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
9261 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
9262 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
9263 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
9264 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
9265 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
9266 so that it will not be output twice.
9267
9268 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
9269 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
9270 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
9271 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
9272 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
9273
9274 @findex recog_data.operand
9275 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
9276 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
9277
9278 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
9279 in the usual way.
9280 @end defmac
9281
9282 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
9283 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
9284 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
9285 they will be output differently.
9286
9287 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9288 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9289 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9290 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
9291 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
9292 by changing the contents of the vector.
9293
9294 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
9295 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
9296 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
9297 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
9298 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
9299 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
9300
9301 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
9302 @end defmac
9303
9304 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
9305 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
9306 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
9307 if necessary.
9308
9309 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9310 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9311 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9312 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
9313 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
9314 by checking the contents of the vector.
9315 @end deftypefn
9316
9317 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
9318 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9319 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
9320 RTL expression.
9321
9322 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
9323 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
9324 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
9325 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
9326 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
9327 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
9328 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
9329
9330 @findex reg_names
9331 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
9332 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
9333 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
9334 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
9335
9336 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
9337 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
9338 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
9339 @var{code}.
9340 @end defmac
9341
9342 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
9343 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
9344 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
9345 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9346 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9347 in this way.
9348 @end defmac
9349
9350 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
9351 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9352 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9353 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9354
9355 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
9356 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
9357 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
9358 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
9359 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
9360 Format}.
9361 @end defmac
9362
9363 @findex dbr_sequence_length
9364 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
9365 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9366 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9367 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9368 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9369 or whatever.
9370
9371 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9372 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9373 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9374 @end defmac
9375
9376 @findex final_sequence
9377 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9378 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9379 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9380 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9381 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9382 being output.
9383
9384 @findex asm_fprintf
9385 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9386 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9387 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9388 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9389 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9390 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9391 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9392 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9393 files can define these macros differently.
9394 @end defmac
9395
9396 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9397 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9398 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9399 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9400 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9401 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9402 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9403 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9404 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9405 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9406 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9407 @end defmac
9408
9409 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9410 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9411 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9412 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9413 first variant.
9414
9415 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9416 @smallexample
9417 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9418 @end smallexample
9419 @noindent
9420 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9421 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9422 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9423 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9424 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9425 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9426 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9427 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9428 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9429
9430 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9431 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9432 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9433
9434 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9435 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9436 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9437 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9438 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9439 opcodes or operand order.
9440 @end defmac
9441
9442 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9443 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9444 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9445 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9446 profiling.
9447 @end defmac
9448
9449 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9450 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9451 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9452 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9453 profiling.
9454 @end defmac
9455
9456 @node Dispatch Tables
9457 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9458
9459 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9460 This concerns dispatch tables.
9461
9462 @cindex dispatch table
9463 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9464 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9465 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9466 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9467 definitions of these labels are output using
9468 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9469 way here. For example,
9470
9471 @smallexample
9472 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9473 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9474 @end smallexample
9475
9476 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9477 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9478 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9479 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9480 mode and flags can be read.
9481 @end defmac
9482
9483 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9484 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9485 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9486
9487 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9488 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9489 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9490 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9491 For example,
9492
9493 @smallexample
9494 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9495 @end smallexample
9496 @end defmac
9497
9498 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9499 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9500 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9501 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9502 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9503 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9504
9505 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9506 for the table.
9507
9508 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9509 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9510 @end defmac
9511
9512 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9513 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9514 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9515 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9516 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9517 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9518 of the preceding label.
9519
9520 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9521 the jump-table.
9522 @end defmac
9523
9524 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_POST_CFI_STARTPROC (FILE *@var{}, @var{tree})
9525 This target hook is used to emit assembly strings required by the target
9526 after the .cfi_startproc directive. The first argument is the file stream to
9527 write the strings to and the second argument is the function's declaration. The
9528 expected use is to add more .cfi_* directives.
9529
9530 The default is to not output any assembly strings.
9531 @end deftypefn
9532
9533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9534 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9535 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9536 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9537 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9538 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9539 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9540 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9541
9542 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9543 @end deftypefn
9544
9545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9546 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9547 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9548 to be broken up according to function.
9549
9550 The default is that no label is emitted.
9551 @end deftypefn
9552
9553 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9554 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9555 @end deftypefn
9556
9557 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9558 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9559 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9560 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9561 @end deftypefn
9562
9563 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9564 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9565 @end deftypevr
9566
9567 @node Exception Region Output
9568 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9569
9570 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9571
9572 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9573 region.
9574
9575 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9576 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9577 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9578 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9579 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9580
9581 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9582 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9583 @end defmac
9584
9585 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9586 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9587 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9588 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9589
9590 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9591 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9592 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9593 be marked as not to be collected.
9594 @end defmac
9595
9596 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9597 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9598 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9599 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9600 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9601 @end defmac
9602
9603 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9604 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9605 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9606 @end defmac
9607
9608 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9609 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9610 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9611 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9612 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9613 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9614 @end defmac
9615
9616 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9617 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9618 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9619 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9620 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9621 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9622 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9623
9624 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9625 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9626 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9627
9628 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9629 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9630 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9631 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9632 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9633 depending on this setting.
9634
9635 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9636 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9637 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9638 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9639 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9640 @end deftypefn
9641
9642 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9643 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9644 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9645 command-line option processing.
9646 @end deftypevr
9647
9648 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9649 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9650 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9651 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9652 @end defmac
9653
9654 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9655 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9656 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9657 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9658 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9659 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9660 @end defmac
9661
9662 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9663 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9664 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9665 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9666 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9667 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{DWARF}. Only applicable if
9668 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9669 @end defmac
9670
9671 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9672 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9673 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9674 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9675 true otherwise.
9676 @end deftypevr
9677
9678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9679 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9680 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9681 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9682 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9683 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9684 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9685 @end deftypefn
9686
9687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9688 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9689 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9690 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9691 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9692 @end deftypefn
9693
9694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9695 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9696 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9697 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9698 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9699 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9700 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9701 @end deftypefn
9702
9703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9704 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9705 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9706 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9707 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9708 @end deftypefn
9709
9710 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9711 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9712 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9713 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9714 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9715 @end deftypevr
9716
9717 @node Alignment Output
9718 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9719
9720 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9721 This describes commands for alignment.
9722
9723 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9724 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9725 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9726
9727 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9728 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9729 define the macro.
9730
9731 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9732 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9733 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9734 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9735 @end defmac
9736
9737 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9738 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9739 a @code{BARRIER}.
9740
9741 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9742 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9743 define the macro.
9744 @end defmac
9745
9746 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9747 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9748 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9749
9750 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9751 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9752 define the macro.
9753
9754 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9755 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9756 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9757 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9758 @end defmac
9759
9760 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9761 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9762 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9763 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9764
9765 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9766 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9767 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9768 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9769 @end defmac
9770
9771 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9772 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9773 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9774 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9775 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9776 @end defmac
9777
9778 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9779 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9780 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9781 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9782 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9783 section.
9784 @end defmac
9785
9786 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9787 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9788 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9789 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9790 @end defmac
9791
9792 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9793 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9794 for padding, if necessary.
9795 @end defmac
9796
9797 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9798 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9799 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9800 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9801 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9802 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9803 @end defmac
9804
9805 @need 3000
9806 @node Debugging Info
9807 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9808
9809 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9810 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9811
9812 @menu
9813 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9814 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9815 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9816 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9817 * DWARF:: Macros for DWARF format.
9818 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9819 @end menu
9820
9821 @node All Debuggers
9822 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9823
9824 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9825 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9826
9827 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9828 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9829 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9830 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9831 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9832 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9833 compiler and another for DBX@.
9834
9835 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9836 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9837 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9838 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9839 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9840
9841 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9842 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9843 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9844 @end defmac
9845
9846 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9847 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9848 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9849 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9850 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9851 that produce debugging output for DBX and allow the frame-pointer to be
9852 eliminated when the @option{-g} option is used.
9853 @end defmac
9854
9855 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9856 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9857 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9858 @var{offset}.
9859 @end defmac
9860
9861 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9862 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9863 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9864 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9865 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9866 @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG},
9867 and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9868
9869 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9870 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9871 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9872 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9873 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9874
9875 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9876 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9877 @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9878 @end defmac
9879
9880 @node DBX Options
9881 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9882
9883 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9884 These are specific options for DBX output.
9885
9886 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9887 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9888 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9889 @end defmac
9890
9891 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9892 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9893 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9894 @end defmac
9895
9896 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9897 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9898 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9899 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9900 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9901 if there is any occasion to.
9902 @end defmac
9903
9904 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9905 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9906 in the text section.
9907 @end defmac
9908
9909 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9910 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9911 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9912 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9913 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9914 @end defmac
9915
9916 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9917 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9918 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9919 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9920 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9921 information format.
9922 @end defmac
9923
9924 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9925 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9926 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9927 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9928 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9929 @end defmac
9930
9931 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9932 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9933 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9934 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9935 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9936 @end defmac
9937
9938 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9939 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9940 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9941 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9942 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9943 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9944 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9945 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9946 @end defmac
9947
9948 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9949 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9950 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9951 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9952 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9953 if backslash is correct for your system.
9954 @end defmac
9955
9956 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9957 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9958 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9959 variable.
9960 @end defmac
9961
9962 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9963 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9964 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9965 @end defmac
9966
9967 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9968 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9969 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9970 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9971 @end defmac
9972
9973 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9974 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9975 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9976 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9977 @end defmac
9978
9979 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9980 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9981 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9982 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9983 @end defmac
9984
9985 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9986 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9987 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9988 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9989 code.
9990 @end defmac
9991
9992 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9993 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9994 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9995 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9996 an absolute address.
9997 @end defmac
9998
9999 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
10000 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
10001 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
10002 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
10003 @end defmac
10004
10005 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
10006 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
10007 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
10008 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
10009 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
10010 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
10011 number for a type number.
10012 @end defmac
10013
10014 @node DBX Hooks
10015 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
10016
10017 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10018 These are hooks for DBX format.
10019
10020 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
10021 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
10022 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
10023 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
10024 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
10025 unique labels in the assembly output.
10026
10027 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
10028 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
10029 @end defmac
10030
10031 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
10032 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
10033 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
10034 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
10035 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
10036 @end defmac
10037
10038 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
10039 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
10040 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
10041 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
10042 @end defmac
10043
10044 @node File Names and DBX
10045 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
10046
10047 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10048 This describes file names in DBX format.
10049
10050 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
10051 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
10052 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
10053 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
10054 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
10055
10056 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
10057 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
10058
10059 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
10060 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
10061 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
10062 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
10063 @end defmac
10064
10065 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
10066 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
10067 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
10068 the beginning of the file.
10069 @end defmac
10070
10071 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
10072 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
10073 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
10074 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
10075 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
10076 @end defmac
10077
10078 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
10079 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
10080 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
10081 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
10082
10083 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
10084 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
10085 @end defmac
10086
10087 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
10088 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
10089 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
10090 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
10091 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
10092 @end defmac
10093
10094 @need 2000
10095 @node DWARF
10096 @subsection Macros for DWARF Output
10097
10098 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10099 Here are macros for DWARF output.
10100
10101 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
10102 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
10103 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
10104
10105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
10106 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
10107 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
10108 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
10109 @end deftypefn
10110
10111 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
10112 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
10113 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
10114 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
10115 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
10116 @end defmac
10117
10118 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
10119 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
10120 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
10121 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
10122 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
10123 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
10124 @end defmac
10125
10126 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
10127 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
10128 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
10129 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
10130 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
10131
10132 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
10133 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
10134
10135 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
10136 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
10137 @end deftypefn
10138
10139 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
10140 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
10141 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
10142 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
10143 @end defmac
10144
10145 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
10146 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler supports view
10147 assignment and verification in @code{.loc}. If it does not, but the
10148 user enables location views, the compiler may have to fallback to
10149 internal line number tables.
10150 @end defmac
10151
10152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RESET_LOCATION_VIEW (rtx_insn *@var{})
10153 This hook, if defined, enables -ginternal-reset-location-views, and
10154 uses its result to override cases in which the estimated min insn
10155 length might be nonzero even when a PC advance (i.e., a view reset)
10156 cannot be taken for granted.
10157
10158 If the hook is defined, it must return a positive value to indicate
10159 the insn definitely advances the PC, and so the view number can be
10160 safely assumed to be reset; a negative value to mean the insn
10161 definitely does not advance the PC, and os the view number must not
10162 be reset; or zero to decide based on the estimated insn length.
10163
10164 If insn length is to be regarded as reliable, set the hook to
10165 @code{hook_int_rtx_insn_0}.
10166 @end deftypefn
10167
10168 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
10169 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
10170 @end deftypevr
10171
10172 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
10173 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
10174 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10175 @end deftypevr
10176
10177 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
10178 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
10179 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10180 @end deftypevr
10181
10182 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
10183 True if register allocation and the passes
10184 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
10185 targets.
10186 @end deftypevr
10187
10188 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10189 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10190 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10191 @end defmac
10192
10193 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10194 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10195 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g.@: instruction
10196 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
10197 @end defmac
10198
10199 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
10200 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
10201 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
10202 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
10203 given @var{section}.
10204 @end defmac
10205
10206 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10207 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
10208 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10209 @end defmac
10210
10211 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10212 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
10213 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10214 @end defmac
10215
10216 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
10217 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
10218 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
10219 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
10220 is referenced by a function.
10221 @end defmac
10222
10223 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
10224 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
10225 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
10226 @end deftypefn
10227
10228 @need 2000
10229 @node VMS Debug
10230 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
10231
10232 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10233 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
10234
10235 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10236 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
10237 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
10238 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
10239 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
10240 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
10241 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
10242 @end defmac
10243
10244 @node Floating Point
10245 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
10246 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
10247 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
10248
10249 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
10250 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
10251 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
10252 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
10253 doing the compilation.
10254
10255 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
10256 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
10257 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
10258 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
10259 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
10260 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
10261 target floating point formats are identical.
10262
10263 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
10264 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
10265 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
10266 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
10267
10268 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
10269 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
10270 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
10271 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
10272 quantity.
10273 @end defmac
10274
10275 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10276 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
10277 @end deftypefn
10278
10279 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10280 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
10281 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
10282 @end deftypefn
10283
10284 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
10285 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
10286 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
10287 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
10288 defined by the C language for both.
10289 @end deftypefn
10290
10291 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10292 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
10293 @end deftypefn
10294
10295 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10296 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
10297 @end deftypefn
10298
10299 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10300 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
10301 @end deftypefn
10302
10303 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10304 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
10305 @end deftypefn
10306
10307 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10308 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
10309 @end deftypefn
10310
10311 @node Mode Switching
10312 @section Mode Switching Instructions
10313 @cindex mode switching
10314 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10315
10316 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
10317 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10318 switching in an optimizing compilation.
10319
10320 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10321 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10322 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10323 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
10324 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
10325 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
10326 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
10327
10328 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10329 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
10330 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
10331 If you define this macro, you also have to define
10332 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10333 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10334 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
10335 are optional.
10336 @end defmac
10337
10338 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10339 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10340 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10341 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10342 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10343 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10344 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10345 entity in question.
10346 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10347 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
10348 switch is needed / supplied.
10349 @end defmac
10350
10351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10352 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10353 @end deftypefn
10354
10355 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10356 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10357 @end deftypefn
10358
10359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10360 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10361 @end deftypefn
10362
10363 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10364 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10365 @end deftypefn
10366
10367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10368 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10369 @end deftypefn
10370
10371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10372 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10373 @end deftypefn
10374
10375 @node Target Attributes
10376 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10377 @cindex target attributes
10378 @cindex machine attributes
10379 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10380
10381 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10382 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10383 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10384
10385 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10386 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10387 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10388 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10389 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10390 take.
10391 @end deftypevr
10392
10393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10394 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10395 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10396 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10397 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10398 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10399 @end deftypefn
10400
10401 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10402 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10403 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10404 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10405 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10406 supposed always to be compatible.
10407 @end deftypefn
10408
10409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10410 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10411 the newly defined @var{type}.
10412 @end deftypefn
10413
10414 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10415 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10416 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10417 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10418 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10419 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10420 merging.
10421 @end deftypefn
10422
10423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10424 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10425 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10426 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10427 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10428 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10429 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10430 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10431
10432 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10433 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10434 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10435 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10436 will then define a function called
10437 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10438 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10439 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10440 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10441 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10442 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10443 @end deftypefn
10444
10445 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10446 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10447 @end deftypefn
10448
10449 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10450 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10451 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10452 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10453 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10454 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10455 on this implementation detail.
10456 @end defmac
10457
10458 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10459 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10460 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10461 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10462 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10463 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10464 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10465 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10466 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10467 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10468 needed.
10469 @end deftypefn
10470
10471 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_HANDLE_GENERIC_ATTRIBUTE (tree *@var{node}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags}, bool *@var{no_add_attrs})
10472 Define this target hook if you want to be able to perform additional
10473 target-specific processing of an attribute which is handled generically
10474 by a front end. The arguments are the same as those which are passed to
10475 attribute handlers. So far this only affects the @var{noinit} and
10476 @var{section} attribute.
10477 @end deftypefn
10478
10479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10480 @cindex inlining
10481 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10482 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10483 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10484 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10485 @end deftypefn
10486
10487 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10488 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10489 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10490 These function-specific options may differ
10491 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10492 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10493
10494 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10495 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10496 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10497 @end deftypefn
10498
10499 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set})
10500 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10501 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10502 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10503 @xref{Option file format}.
10504 @end deftypefn
10505
10506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10507 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10508 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10509 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10510 @end deftypefn
10511
10512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10513 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10514 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10515 LTO bytecode.
10516 @end deftypefn
10517
10518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10519 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10520 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10521 function-specific options.
10522 @end deftypefn
10523
10524 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10525 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10526 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10527 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10528 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10529 @end deftypefn
10530
10531 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10532 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10533 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10534 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10535 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10536
10537 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10538 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10539
10540 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10541 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10542 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10543 @end deftypefn
10544
10545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10546 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10547 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10548 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10549 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10550 different target machines.
10551 @end deftypefn
10552
10553 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10554 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10555 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10556 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10557 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10558 @end deftypefn
10559
10560 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10561 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10562 @end deftypefn
10563
10564 @node Emulated TLS
10565 @section Emulating TLS
10566 @cindex Emulated TLS
10567
10568 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10569 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10570 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10571 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10572 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10573 layer.
10574
10575 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10576 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10577 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10578 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10579
10580 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10581 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10582 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10583 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10584 @end deftypevr
10585
10586 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10587 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10588 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10589 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10590 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10591 registration function to be used.
10592 @end deftypevr
10593
10594 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10595 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10596 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10597 any section.
10598 @end deftypevr
10599
10600 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10601 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10602 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10603 section.
10604 @end deftypevr
10605
10606 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10607 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10608 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10609 @end deftypevr
10610
10611 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10612 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10613 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10614 @end deftypevr
10615
10616 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10617 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10618 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10619 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10620 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10621 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10622 @end deftypefn
10623
10624 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10625 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10626 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10627 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10628 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10629 @end deftypefn
10630
10631 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10632 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10633 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10634 single objects. The default is false.
10635 @end deftypevr
10636
10637 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10638 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10639 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10640 @end deftypevr
10641
10642 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10643 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10644 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10645
10646 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10647 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10648 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10649 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10650
10651 @smallexample
10652 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10653 unsigned int d;
10654
10655 d = cp0count + 3;
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10659 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10660 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10661
10662 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10663 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10664 later in the function.
10665
10666 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10667 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10668 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10669
10670 @node PCH Target
10671 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10672 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10673
10674 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10675 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10676 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10677 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10678 @end deftypefn
10679
10680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10681 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10682 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10683 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10684 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10685
10686 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10687 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10688 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10689 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10690
10691 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10692 suitable for most targets.
10693 @end deftypefn
10694
10695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10696 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10697 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10698 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10699 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10700 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10701 @end deftypefn
10702
10703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10704 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10705 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10706 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10707 to do anything here.
10708 @end deftypefn
10709
10710 @node C++ ABI
10711 @section C++ ABI parameters
10712 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10713
10714 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10715 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10716 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10717 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10718 @end deftypefn
10719
10720 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10721 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10722 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10723 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10724 @end deftypefn
10725
10726 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10727 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10728 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10729 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10730 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10731 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10732 @end deftypefn
10733
10734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10735 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10736 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10737 @end deftypefn
10738
10739 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10740 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10741 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10742 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10743 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10744 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10745 backend's targeted operating system.
10746 @end deftypefn
10747
10748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10749 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10750 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10751 @code{false}.
10752 @end deftypefn
10753
10754 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10755 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10756 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10757 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10758 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10759 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10760 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10761 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10762 @end deftypefn
10763
10764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10765 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10766 @end deftypefn
10767
10768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10769 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10770 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10771 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10772 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10773 unit will not be COMDAT.
10774 @end deftypefn
10775
10776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10777 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10778 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10779 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10780 @end deftypefn
10781
10782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10783 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10784 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10785 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10786 @end deftypefn
10787
10788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10789 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10790 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10791 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10792 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10793 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10794 @end deftypefn
10795
10796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10797 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10798 @end deftypefn
10799
10800 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10801 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10802 @end deftypefn
10803
10804 @node D Language and ABI
10805 @section D ABI parameters
10806 @cindex parameters, d abi
10807
10808 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS (void)
10809 Declare all environmental version identifiers relating to the target CPU
10810 using the function @code{builtin_version}, which takes a string representing
10811 the name of the version. Version identifiers predefined by this hook apply
10812 to all modules that are being compiled and imported.
10813 @end deftypefn
10814
10815 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_OS_VERSIONS (void)
10816 Similarly to @code{TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS}, but is used for versions
10817 relating to the target operating system.
10818 @end deftypefn
10819
10820 @node Named Address Spaces
10821 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10822 @cindex named address spaces
10823
10824 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10825 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10826 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10827 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10828 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10829 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10830 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10831 @code{const} type attributes.
10832
10833 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10834 pointers to the generic address space.
10835
10836 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10837 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10838 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10839 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10840 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10841 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10842 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10843 always 32 bits).
10844
10845 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10846 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10847 address space.
10848
10849 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10850 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10851 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10852 named address space #1:
10853 @smallexample
10854 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10855 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10859 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10860 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10861 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10862 @end deftypefn
10863
10864 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10865 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10866 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10867 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10868 @end deftypefn
10869
10870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10871 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10872 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10873 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10874 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10875 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10876 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10877 target hooks for the given address space.
10878 @end deftypefn
10879
10880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10881 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10882 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10883 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10884 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10885 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10886 explicit named address space support.
10887 @end deftypefn
10888
10889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10890 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10891 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10892 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10893 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10894 @end deftypefn
10895
10896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10897 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10898 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10899 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10900 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10901 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10902 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10903 @end deftypefn
10904
10905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10906 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10907 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10908 @end deftypefn
10909
10910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10911 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10912 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10913 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10914 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10915 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10916 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10917 @end deftypefn
10918
10919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10920 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10921 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10922 @end deftypefn
10923
10924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10925 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10926 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10927 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10928 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10929 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10930 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10931 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10932 The default implementation does nothing.
10933 @end deftypefn
10934
10935 @node Misc
10936 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10937 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10938
10939 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10940 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10941
10942 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10943 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10944 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10945 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10946 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10947 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10948 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10949 @end defmac
10950
10951 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10952 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10953 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10954 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10955 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10956 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10957 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10958 @end defmac
10959
10960 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10961 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10962 elements of a jump-table should have.
10963 @end defmac
10964
10965 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10966 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10967 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10968 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10969 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10970 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10971 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10972 flags can be updated.
10973 @end defmac
10974
10975 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10976 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10977 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10978 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10979 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10980 is in effect.
10981 @end defmac
10982
10983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10984 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10985 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10986 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10987 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10988 @end deftypefn
10989
10990 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10991 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10992 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register. To be
10993 more explicit, if you start with a pair of @code{word_mode} registers with
10994 known values and you do a subword, for example @code{QImode}, addition on
10995 the low part of the registers, then the compiler may consider that the
10996 result has a known value in @code{word_mode} too if the macro is defined
10997 to 1. Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10998 @end defmac
10999
11000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
11001 On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
11002 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
11003 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
11004
11005 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
11006 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
11007 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
11008
11009 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
11010 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
11011 with a precision lower than the word precision.
11012
11013 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
11014 defined to 1.
11015 @end deftypefn
11016
11017 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
11018 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
11019 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
11020 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
11021 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
11022 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
11023 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
11024 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
11025
11026 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
11027 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
11028 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
11029 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
11030 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
11031
11032 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
11033 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
11034 of these hard registers @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false
11035 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
11036 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
11037
11038 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
11039 mode, @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
11040 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
11041 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
11042 @end defmac
11043
11044 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
11045 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
11046 extends.
11047 @end defmac
11048
11049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
11050 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
11051 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
11052 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
11053 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
11054 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
11055 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
11056 @end deftypefn
11057
11058 @defmac MOVE_MAX
11059 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
11060 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
11061 @end defmac
11062
11063 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
11064 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
11065 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
11066 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
11067 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
11068 at run-time.
11069 @end defmac
11070
11071 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
11072 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
11073 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
11074 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
11075 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
11076 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
11077 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
11078 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
11079 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11080 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
11081 arguments to bit-field instructions.
11082
11083 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
11084 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
11085 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
11086
11087 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
11088 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
11089 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
11090 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
11091 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
11092
11093 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
11094 @end defmac
11095
11096 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
11097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
11098 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
11099 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
11100 @xref{shift patterns}.
11101
11102 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
11103 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
11104 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
11105 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
11106 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
11107 particular behavior is guaranteed.
11108
11109 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
11110 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
11111 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
11112
11113 The default implementation of this function returns
11114 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11115 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
11116 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
11117 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
11118 by overriding it.
11119 @end deftypefn
11120
11121 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (poly_uint64 @var{outprec}, poly_uint64 @var{inprec})
11122 This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of
11123 @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is
11124 smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only
11125 @var{outprec} bits. The default returns true unconditionally, which
11126 is correct for most machines. When @code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION}
11127 returns false, the machine description should provide a @code{trunc}
11128 optab to specify the RTL that performs the required truncation.
11129
11130 If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes,
11131 suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding
11132 mode sizes. Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things.
11133 @end deftypefn
11134
11135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode})
11136 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
11137 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
11138 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
11139 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
11140 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
11141 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
11142 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
11143 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
11144 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
11145 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
11146
11147 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
11148 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
11149 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
11150 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false.
11151
11152 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
11153 describe two related properties. If you define
11154 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
11155 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
11156 extension.
11157
11158 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
11159 @code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
11160 @code{mode}.
11161 @end deftypefn
11162
11163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SETJMP_PRESERVES_NONVOLATILE_REGS_P (void)
11164 On some targets, it is assumed that the compiler will spill all pseudos
11165 that are live across a call to @code{setjmp}, while other targets treat
11166 @code{setjmp} calls as normal function calls.
11167
11168 This hook returns false if @code{setjmp} calls do not preserve all
11169 non-volatile registers so that gcc that must spill all pseudos that are
11170 live across @code{setjmp} calls. Define this to return true if the
11171 target does not need to spill all pseudos live across @code{setjmp} calls.
11172 The default implementation conservatively assumes all pseudos must be
11173 spilled across @code{setjmp} calls.
11174 @end deftypefn
11175
11176 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
11177 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
11178 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
11179 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
11180 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
11181 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
11182
11183 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
11184 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
11185 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
11186 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
11187 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
11188 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
11189 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
11190 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
11191 the compiler.
11192
11193 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
11194 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
11195 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
11196 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
11197 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
11198 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
11199 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
11200 expression
11201
11202 @smallexample
11203 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
11204 @end smallexample
11205
11206 @noindent
11207 can be converted to
11208
11209 @smallexample
11210 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
11211 @end smallexample
11212
11213 @noindent
11214 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
11215 tested into the sign bit.
11216
11217 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
11218 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
11219 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
11220 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
11221 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
11222 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
11223
11224 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
11225 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
11226 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
11227 to be used:
11228
11229 @itemize @bullet
11230 @item
11231 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
11232 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
11233 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
11234 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
11235 combine the normalization with other operations.
11236
11237 @item
11238 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
11239 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
11240 other machines.
11241
11242 @item
11243 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
11244 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
11245 others.
11246
11247 @item
11248 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
11249 @end itemize
11250
11251 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
11252 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
11253 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
11254 those cases, e.g., one matching
11255
11256 @smallexample
11257 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
11258 @end smallexample
11259
11260 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
11261 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
11262 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
11263 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
11264 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
11265 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
11266 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
11267 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
11268
11269 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
11270 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
11271 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
11272 @end defmac
11273
11274 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11275 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
11276 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
11277 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
11278 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
11279 this macro.
11280 @end defmac
11281
11282 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11283 A C expression that gives an rtx representing the nonzero true element
11284 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
11285 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
11286 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
11287 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
11288 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
11289 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
11290 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
11291 given mode.
11292 @end defmac
11293
11294 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11295 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11296 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
11297 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
11298 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
11299 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
11300 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
11301 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
11302 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
11303 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
11304 this value.
11305
11306 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
11307 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
11308
11309 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
11310 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
11311 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
11312 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
11313
11314 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
11315 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
11316 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
11317 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
11318 breaking the API@.
11319 @end defmac
11320
11321 @defmac Pmode
11322 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
11323 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
11324 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
11325 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
11326 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
11327
11328 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
11329 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
11330 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
11331 to @code{Pmode}.
11332 @end defmac
11333
11334 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
11335 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
11336 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
11337 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
11338 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
11339 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
11340 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
11341 @end defmac
11342
11343 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
11344 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
11345 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
11346 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
11347 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
11348 strict conformance to the C Standard.
11349
11350 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
11351 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11352 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
11353 @end defmac
11354
11355 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11356 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11357
11358 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11359 @end deftypefn
11360
11361 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11362 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11363 @end deftypefn
11364
11365 @defmac SYSTEM_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
11366 Define this macro if the system header files do not support C++@.
11367 This macro handles system header files by pretending that system
11368 header files are enclosed in @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
11369 @end defmac
11370
11371 @findex #pragma
11372 @findex pragma
11373 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11374 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11375 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11376 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11377 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
11378 setup required for the pragmas.
11379
11380 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11381 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
11382 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11383
11384 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11385 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11386
11387 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11388 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11389 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11390 @end defmac
11391
11392 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11393 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11394
11395 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11396 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
11397 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11398 pragma of the form
11399
11400 @smallexample
11401 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11402 @end smallexample
11403
11404 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11405 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11406 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11407 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11408 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11409 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11410 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11411 arguments of pragmas registered with
11412 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11413 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11414
11415 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11416 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11417 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11418 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11419 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11420 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11421 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11422 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11423 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11424 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11425 how to build this object file.
11426 @end deftypefun
11427
11428 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11429 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11430 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11431 @end defmac
11432
11433 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11434 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11435 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11436 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11437 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11438 @end defmac
11439
11440 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11441 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11442 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11443 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11444 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11445 @end defmac
11446
11447 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11448 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11449 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11450 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11451 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11452 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11453 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11454 you should define this macro.
11455
11456 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11457 @end defmac
11458
11459 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11460 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11461 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11462 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11463 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11464 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11465 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11466 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11467 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11468 slot of @var{insn}.
11469
11470 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11471 @end defmac
11472
11473 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11474 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11475 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11476 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11477 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11478 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11479
11480 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11481 @end defmac
11482
11483 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11484 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11485 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11486 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11487 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11488
11489 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11490 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11491 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11492 @end deftypefn
11493
11494 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11495 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11496 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11497 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11498 separate math library.
11499
11500 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11501 @end defmac
11502
11503 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11504 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11505 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11506
11507 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11508 is wrong.
11509 @end defmac
11510
11511 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11512 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11513 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11514 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11515 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11516 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11517 for cross-profiling.
11518 @end defmac
11519
11520 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11521
11522 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11523 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11524 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11525 1 if it does use cc0.
11526 @end defmac
11527
11528 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11529 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11530 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11531 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11532 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11533 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11534 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11535 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11536 @end defmac
11537
11538 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11539 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11540 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11541 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11542 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11543 @end defmac
11544
11545 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11546 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11547 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11548 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11549 about the currently processed blocks.
11550 @end defmac
11551
11552 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11553 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11554 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11555 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11556 to by @var{ce_info}.
11557 @end defmac
11558
11559 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11560 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11561 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11562 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11563 to by @var{ce_info}.
11564 @end defmac
11565
11566 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11567 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11568 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11569 to by @var{ce_info}.
11570 @end defmac
11571
11572 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11573 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11574 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11575 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11576
11577 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11578 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11579 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11580 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11581
11582 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11583 definition is null.
11584 @end deftypefn
11585
11586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11587 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11588 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11589 necessary setup.
11590
11591 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11592 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11593 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11594 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11595
11596 To create a built-in function, call the function
11597 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11598 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11599 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11600 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11601 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11602 @end deftypefn
11603
11604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11605 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11606 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11607 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11608 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11609 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11610 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11611 @code{error_mark_node}.
11612 @end deftypefn
11613
11614 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11615
11616 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11617 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11618 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11619 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11620 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11621 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11622 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11623 built-in function.
11624 @end deftypefn
11625
11626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11627 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11628 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11629 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11630 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11631 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11632 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11633 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11634 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11635 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11636 @end deftypefn
11637
11638 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CHECK_BUILTIN_CALL (location_t @var{loc}, vec<location_t> @var{arg_loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{orig_fndecl}, unsigned int @var{nargs}, tree *@var{args})
11639 Perform semantic checking on a call to a machine-specific built-in
11640 function after its arguments have been constrained to the function
11641 signature. Return true if the call is valid, otherwise report an error
11642 and return false.
11643
11644 This hook is called after @code{TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN}.
11645 The call was originally to built-in function @var{orig_fndecl},
11646 but after the optional @code{TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN}
11647 step is now to built-in function @var{fndecl}. @var{loc} is the
11648 location of the call and @var{args} is an array of function arguments,
11649 of which there are @var{nargs}. @var{arg_loc} specifies the location
11650 of each argument.
11651 @end deftypefn
11652
11653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11654 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11655 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11656 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11657 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11658 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11659 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11660 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11661 @end deftypefn
11662
11663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11664 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11665 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11666 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11667 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11668 @end deftypefn
11669
11670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11671 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11672 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11673 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11674 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11675 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11676 the two function decls that will be compared.
11677 @end deftypefn
11678
11679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11680 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11681 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11682 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11683 identical versions.
11684 @end deftypefn
11685
11686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11687 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11688 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11689 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11690 body must be generated.
11691 @end deftypefn
11692
11693 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PREDICT_DOLOOP_P (class loop *@var{loop})
11694 Return true if we can predict it is possible to use a low-overhead loop
11695 for a particular loop. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to the loop.
11696 This target hook is required only when the target supports low-overhead
11697 loops, and will help ivopts to make some decisions.
11698 The default version of this hook returns false.
11699 @end deftypefn
11700
11701 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_COUNT_REG_DECR_P
11702 Return true if the target supports hardware count register for decrement
11703 and branch.
11704 The default value is false.
11705 @end deftypevr
11706
11707 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int64_t TARGET_DOLOOP_COST_FOR_GENERIC
11708 One IV candidate dedicated for doloop is introduced in IVOPTs, we can
11709 calculate the computation cost of adopting it to any generic IV use by
11710 function get_computation_cost as before. But for targets which have
11711 hardware count register support for decrement and branch, it may have to
11712 move IV value from hardware count register to general purpose register
11713 while doloop IV candidate is used for generic IV uses. It probably takes
11714 expensive penalty. This hook allows target owners to define the cost for
11715 this especially for generic IV uses.
11716 The default value is zero.
11717 @end deftypevr
11718
11719 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int64_t TARGET_DOLOOP_COST_FOR_ADDRESS
11720 One IV candidate dedicated for doloop is introduced in IVOPTs, we can
11721 calculate the computation cost of adopting it to any address IV use by
11722 function get_computation_cost as before. But for targets which have
11723 hardware count register support for decrement and branch, it may have to
11724 move IV value from hardware count register to general purpose register
11725 while doloop IV candidate is used for address IV uses. It probably takes
11726 expensive penalty. This hook allows target owners to define the cost for
11727 this escpecially for address IV uses.
11728 The default value is zero.
11729 @end deftypevr
11730
11731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11732 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11733 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11734 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11735 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11736 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11737 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11738 loop is only entered from the top.
11739
11740 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11741 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11742 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11743 @end deftypefn
11744
11745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11746
11747 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11748 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11749 could not be applied.
11750
11751 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11752 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11753 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11754 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11755 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11756 @end deftypefn
11757
11758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11759 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11760 @end deftypefn
11761
11762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11763 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11764 @end deftypefn
11765
11766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11767 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11768 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11769 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11770 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11771 @end deftypefn
11772
11773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11774
11775 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11776 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11777 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11778 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11779 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11780 that had its initial value copied by using
11781 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11782 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11783 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11784 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11785 @code{MEM}.
11786 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11787 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11788 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11789 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11790 register in question will not be clobbered.
11791 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11792 allocation.
11793 @end deftypefn
11794
11795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11796 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11797 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11798 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11799 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11800 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11801 passed along.
11802 @end deftypefn
11803
11804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11805 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11806 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11807 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11808 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11809 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11810 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11811 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11812 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11813 The default hook function does nothing.
11814
11815 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11816 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11817 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11818 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11819 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11820 outside of any function scope.
11821 @end deftypefn
11822
11823 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11824 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11825 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11826 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11827 @end defmac
11828
11829 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11830 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11831 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11832 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11833 executable files.
11834 @end defmac
11835
11836 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11837 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11838 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11839 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11840 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11841 lists.
11842 @end defmac
11843
11844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11845 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11846 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11847 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11848 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11849
11850 @smallexample
11851 static bool
11852 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11853 @{
11854 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11855 @}
11856 @end smallexample
11857 @end deftypefn
11858
11859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11860 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11861 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11862 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11863 @end deftypefn
11864
11865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11866 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11867 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11868 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11869 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11870 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11871 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11872 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11873 @end deftypefn
11874
11875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11876 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11877 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11878 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11879 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11880 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11881 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11882 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11883 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11884 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11885 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11886 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11887 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11888 @end deftypefn
11889
11890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, class loop *@var{loop})
11891 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11892 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11893 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11894 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11895 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11896 number of memory accesses.
11897 @end deftypefn
11898
11899 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11900 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11901 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11902 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11903 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11904 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11905 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11906 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11907 @end defmac
11908
11909 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11910 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11911 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11912 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11913 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11914 @end deftypefn
11915
11916 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11917 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11918 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11919 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11920 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11921 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11922 @end deftypefn
11923
11924 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11925 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11926 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11927 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11928 that are different from @option{-I}.
11929 @end deftypefn
11930
11931 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11932 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11933 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11934 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11935 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11936 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11937 @end defmac
11938
11939 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11940 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11941 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11942 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11943 @end defmac
11944
11945 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11946 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11947 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11948 @end defmac
11949
11950 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11951 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11952 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11953 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11954 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11955 @end defmac
11956
11957 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11958 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11959 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11960 @end defmac
11961
11962 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11963 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11964 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11965 and scanf formatter settings.
11966 @end defmac
11967
11968 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11969 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11970 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11971 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11972 @end deftypefn
11973
11974 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11975 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11976 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11977 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11978 @end deftypefn
11979
11980 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11981 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11982 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11983 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11984 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11985 @end deftypefn
11986
11987 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11988 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11989 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11990 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11991 the front end.
11992 @end deftypefn
11993
11994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11995 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11996 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11997 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11998 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11999 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
12000 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
12001 @end deftypefn
12002
12003 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
12004 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
12005 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
12006 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
12007 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
12008 conversion rules.
12009 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
12010 @end deftypefn
12011
12012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VERIFY_TYPE_CONTEXT (location_t @var{loc}, type_context_kind @var{context}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{silent_p})
12013 If defined, this hook returns false if there is a target-specific reason
12014 why type @var{type} cannot be used in the source language context described
12015 by @var{context}. When @var{silent_p} is false, the hook also reports an
12016 error against @var{loc} for invalid uses of @var{type}.
12017
12018 Calls to this hook should be made through the global function
12019 @code{verify_type_context}, which makes the @var{silent_p} parameter
12020 default to false and also handles @code{error_mark_node}.
12021
12022 The default implementation always returns true.
12023 @end deftypefn
12024
12025 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
12026 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
12027 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
12028 @end defmac
12029
12030 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
12031 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
12032 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
12033 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
12034 and the associated definitions of those functions.
12035 @end defmac
12036
12037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
12038 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
12039 necessary.
12040 @end deftypefn
12041
12042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
12043 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
12044 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
12045 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
12046 is needed.
12047 @end deftypefn
12048
12049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
12050 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
12051 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
12052 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
12053 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
12054 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
12055 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
12056 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
12057 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
12058 @end deftypefn
12059
12060 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
12061 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
12062 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
12063 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
12064 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
12065 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
12066 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
12067 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
12068 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
12069 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
12070 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
12071 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
12072 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
12073 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
12074 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
12075 is zero, which disables this optimization.
12076 @end deftypevr
12077
12078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
12079 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
12080 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
12081 supported by the target.
12082 @end deftypefn
12083
12084 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
12085 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
12086 memory model bits are allowed.
12087 @end deftypefn
12088
12089 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
12090 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e.@: the @code{bool} @code{true}.
12091 @end deftypevr
12092
12093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
12094 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
12095 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
12096 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
12097 @end deftypefn
12098
12099 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
12100 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
12101 @end deftypefn
12102
12103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
12104 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
12105 @end deftypefn
12106
12107 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
12108 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
12109 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
12110 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
12111 @end deftypefn
12112
12113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
12114 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
12115 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
12116 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
12117 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
12118 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
12119
12120 @end deftypefn
12121
12122 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
12123
12124 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
12125 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
12126 to indicate that large integers are stored in
12127 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
12128 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
12129 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
12130 representation.
12131
12132 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
12133 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
12134 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
12135 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
12136 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
12137
12138 @itemize @bullet
12139 @item
12140 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
12141 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
12142 language since there are a variable number of elements.
12143
12144 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
12145 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
12146 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
12147 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
12148 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
12149 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
12150 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
12151 not really a large change.
12152
12153 @item
12154 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
12155 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
12156 port in this code.
12157
12158 @item
12159 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
12160 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
12161 @end itemize
12162
12163 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
12164 maintainer is familiar with.
12165
12166 @end defmac
12167
12168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (bool @var{active})
12169 This hook is used to determine the level of target support for
12170 @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}. If called with an argument
12171 of false, it returns true if the target has been modified to support
12172 this builtin. If called with an argument of true, it returns true
12173 if the target requires active mitigation execution might be speculative.
12174
12175 The default implementation returns false if the target does not define
12176 a pattern named @code{speculation_barrier}. Else it returns true
12177 for the first case and whether the pattern is enabled for the current
12178 compilation for the second case.
12179
12180 For targets that have no processors that can execute instructions
12181 speculatively an alternative implemenation of this hook is available:
12182 simply redefine this hook to @code{speculation_safe_value_not_needed}
12183 along with your other target hooks.
12184 @end deftypefn
12185
12186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{result}, rtx @var{val}, rtx @var{failval})
12187 This target hook can be used to generate a target-specific code
12188 sequence that implements the @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}
12189 built-in function. The function must always return @var{val} in
12190 @var{result} in mode @var{mode} when the cpu is not executing
12191 speculatively, but must never return that when speculating until it
12192 is known that the speculation will not be unwound. The hook supports
12193 two primary mechanisms for implementing the requirements. The first
12194 is to emit a speculation barrier which forces the processor to wait
12195 until all prior speculative operations have been resolved; the second
12196 is to use a target-specific mechanism that can track the speculation
12197 state and to return @var{failval} if it can determine that
12198 speculation must be unwound at a later time.
12199
12200 The default implementation simply copies @var{val} to @var{result} and
12201 emits a @code{speculation_barrier} instruction if that is defined.
12202 @end deftypefn
12203
12204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
12205 If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
12206 @end deftypefn